FREESCALE MC68HC908RF2A

MC68HC908RF2A
Data Sheet
M68HC08
Microcontrollers
MC68HC908RF2A
Rev. 0
10/2004
freescale.com
MC68HC908RF2A
Data Sheet
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the World Wide Web will be
the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information
available, refer to:
http://freescale.com/
The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this document. For your
convenience, the page number designators have been linked to the appropriate location.
Revision History
Date
Revision
Level
October,
2004
N/A
Description
Initial release
Page
Number(s)
N/A
Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
This product incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST.
© Freescale Semiconductor, Inc., 2004. All rights reserved.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
3
Revision History
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
4
Freescale Semiconductor
List of Chapters
Chapter 1 General Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Chapter 2 Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Chapter 3 Configuration Register (CONFIG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Chapter 4 Computer Operating Properly Module (COP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Chapter 5 Central Processor Unit (CPU). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Chapter 6 Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Chapter 7 Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Chapter 8 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Chapter 9 Input/Output (I/O) Ports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Chapter 10 System Integration Module (SIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Chapter 11 Timer Interface Module (TIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Chapter 12 PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Chapter 13 Development Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Chapter 14 Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Chapter 15 Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
5
List of Chapters
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
6
Freescale Semiconductor
Table of Contents
Chapter 1
General Description
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.4.1
1.4.2
1.4.3
1.4.4
1.4.5
1.4.6
1.4.7
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Reset (RST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Port A Input/Output Pins (PTA7, PTA6/KBD6–PTA1/KBD1, and PTA0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Port B Input/Output Pins (PTB3/TCLK, PTB2/TCH0, PTB1, and PTB0/MCLK) . . . . . . . . .
UHF Transmitter Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15
15
16
18
18
19
19
19
19
19
19
Chapter 2
Memory
2.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2
Input/Output Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.3
Monitor ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.4
Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5
FLASH 2TS Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.1
FLASH 2TS Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.2
FLASH 2TS Charge Pump Frequency Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.3
FLASH 2TS Erase Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.4
FLASH 2TS Program/Margin Read Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.5
FLASH 2TS Block Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.6
FLASH 2TS Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.7
Embedded Program/Erase Routines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.8
Embedded Function Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.8.1
RDVRRNG Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.8.2
PRGRNGE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.8.3
ERARNGE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.8.4
REDPROG Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.8.5
Example Routine Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.9
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.9.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5.9.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21
21
27
27
28
29
30
30
31
33
33
34
35
35
36
36
37
38
40
40
40
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
7
Table of Contents
Chapter 3
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
3.1
3.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Chapter 4
Computer Operating Properly Module (COP)
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.3.1
4.3.2
4.3.3
4.3.4
4.3.5
4.3.6
4.3.7
4.3.8
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7
4.7.1
4.7.2
4.8
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CGMXCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
STOP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power-On Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reset Vector Fetch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
COPD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
COPRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
COP Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
COP Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
43
43
44
44
44
44
44
44
44
45
45
45
45
45
45
45
45
46
Chapter 5
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.3.1
5.3.2
5.3.3
5.3.4
5.3.5
5.4
5.5
5.5.1
5.5.2
5.6
5.7
5.8
Contents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
47
47
47
48
48
49
49
50
51
51
51
51
51
52
57
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
8
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 6
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
6.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.2
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.1
Clock Enable Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.2
Internal Clock Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.2.1
Digitally Controlled Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.2.2
Modulo N Divider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.2.3
Frequency Comparator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.2.4
Digital Loop Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.3
External Clock Generator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.3.1
External Oscillator Amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.3.2
External Clock Input Path . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4
Clock Monitor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.1
Clock Monitor Reference Generator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.2
Internal Clock Activity Detector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.3
External Clock Activity Detector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.5
Clock Selection Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.5.1
Clock Selection Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.5.2
Clock Switching Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4
Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.1
Switching Clock Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.2
Enabling the Clock Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.3
Clock Monitor Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.4
Quantization Error in DCO Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.4.1
Digitally Controlled Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.4.2
Binary Weighted Divider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.4.3
Variable-Delay Ring Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.4.4
Ring Oscillator Fine-Adjust Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.5
Switching Internal Clock Frequencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.6
Nominal Frequency Settling Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.6.1
Settling to Within 15 Percent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.6.2
Settling to Within 5 Percent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.6.3
Total Settling Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.7
Improving Settling Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.8
Trimming Frequency on the Internal Clock Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.6
Configuration Register Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.6.1
EXTSLOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7
I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7.1
ICG Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7.2
ICG Multiplier Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7.3
ICG Trim Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7.4
ICG DCO Divider Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7.5
ICG DCO Stage Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
59
59
59
59
61
61
62
62
62
63
63
64
64
64
66
66
66
67
67
68
68
69
70
70
70
70
71
71
71
72
72
73
73
74
75
76
76
76
76
76
77
78
80
80
81
81
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
9
Table of Contents
Chapter 7
Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI)
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.3.1
7.3.2
7.3.3
7.3.4
7.3.5
7.4
7.4.1
7.4.2
7.5
7.5.1
7.5.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
IRQ Pin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
KBI Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keyboard Interrupt Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keyboard Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
IRQ and Keyboard Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
83
83
83
83
87
88
88
89
89
89
89
90
90
91
Chapter 8
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.3.1
8.3.2
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.6.1
8.6.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
False Trip Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Short Stop Recovery Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LVI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LVI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
93
93
93
94
94
94
95
95
95
95
Chapter 9
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
9.1
9.2
9.2.1
9.2.2
9.3
9.3.1
9.3.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Port A Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Data Direction Register A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Port B Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Data Direction Register B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Chapter 10
System Integration Module (SIM)
10.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.2 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.2.1
Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.2.2
Clock Startup from POR or LVI Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.2.3
Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
103
105
105
105
105
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
10
Freescale Semiconductor
10.3 Reset and System Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.1
External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.2
Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.2.1
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.2.2
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.2.3
Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.2.4
Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.2.5
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4 SIM Counter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4.1
SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4.2
SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4.3
SIM Counter and Reset States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.5 Program Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.5.1
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.5.1.1
Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.5.1.2
SWI Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.5.2
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.5.3
Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.5.4
Status Flag Protection in Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.6.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.6.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7 SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.1
SIM Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2
SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3
SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
105
106
106
107
107
107
108
108
108
108
108
108
108
109
111
112
112
112
112
112
112
114
115
115
115
116
Chapter 11
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
11.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
11.4.1
11.4.2
11.4.3
11.4.4
11.4.5
11.4.6
11.4.7
11.4.8
11.4.9
11.5
11.5.1
11.5.2
11.5.3
11.6
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TIM Counter Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PWM Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TIM During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
117
117
117
119
121
121
121
121
122
122
123
123
124
124
125
125
125
125
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
11
Table of Contents
11.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.7.1
TIM Clock Pin (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.7.2
TIM Channel I/O Pins (TCH0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.8 I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.8.1
TIM Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.8.2
TIM Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.8.3
TIM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.8.4
TIM Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.8.5
TIM Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
125
125
126
126
126
127
128
129
132
Chapter 12
PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module
12.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.2 Transmitter Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3 Phase-Lock Loop (PLL) and Local Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4 RF Output Stage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5 Modulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.6 Microcontroller Interfaces. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.7 State Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.8 Power Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.9 Data Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.10 Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.10.1
Application Schematics in OOK and FSK Modulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.10.2
Complete Application Schematic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
133
135
135
135
136
136
137
139
139
139
139
141
Chapter 13
Development Support
13.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2 Break Module (BRK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.1
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.1.1
Flag Protection During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.1.2
CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.1.3
TIM During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.1.4
COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.2.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.2.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.3
Break Module Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.3.1
Break Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.3.2
Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3 Monitor Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1.1
Monitor Mode Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1.2
Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1.3
Echoing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1.4
Break Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1.5
Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1.6
Baud Rate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.2
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
143
143
143
143
144
144
144
145
145
145
145
145
146
146
146
148
149
149
150
150
153
153
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
12
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14
Electrical Specifications
14.1
14.2
14.3
14.4
14.5
14.6
14.7
14.8
14.8.1
14.8.2
14.9
14.10
14.11
14.12
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Operating Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.8-Volt to 3.3-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UHF Transmitter Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UHF Module Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UHF Module Output Power Measurement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LVI Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
155
155
156
156
157
158
159
160
160
164
165
166
166
167
Chapter 15
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
15.1
15.2
15.3
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
32-Pin LQFP Package (Case No. 873A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
13
Table of Contents
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
14
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 1
General Description
1.1 Introduction
The MC68HC908RF2A MCU is a member of the low-cost, high-performance M68HC08 Family of 8-bit
microcontroller units (MCUs). Optimized for low-power operation and available in a small 32-pin
low-profile quad flat pack (LQFP), this MCU is well suited for remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitter
designs.
All MCUs in the family use the enhanced M68HC08 central processor unit (CPU08) and are available with
a variety of modules, memory sizes and types, and package types.
1.2 Features
Features MCU include:
• High-performance M68HC08 architecture
• Fully upward-compatible object code with M6805, M146805, and M68HC05 Families
• Maximum internal bus frequency of 4 MHz at 3.3 volts
• Maximum internal bus frequency of 2 MHz at 1.8 volts
• Internal oscillator requiring no external components:
– Software selectable bus frequencies
– ± 25 percent accuracy with trim capability to ±2 percent
– Option to allow use of external clock source or external crystal/ceramic resonator
• 2 Kbytes of on-chip FLASH memory
• FLASH program memory security(1)
• 128 bytes of on-chip RAM
• 16-bit, 2-channel timer interface module (TIM)
• 12 general-purpose input/output (I/O) ports:
– Six shared with keyboard wakeup function
– Two shared with the timer module
– Port A pins have 3-mA sink capabilities
• Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module:
– 1.85-V detection forces MCU into reset
– 2.0-V detection sets indicator flag
• 6-bit keyboard interrupt with wakeup feature
• External asynchronous interrupt pin with internal pullup (IRQ)
• Ultra high frequency (UHF) transmitter
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Freescale’s strategy is to make reading or copying the FLASH difficult for
unauthorized users.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
15
General Description
•
•
•
•
•
System protection features:
– Computer operating properly (COP) reset
– Low-voltage detection with reset
– Illegal opcode detection with reset
– Illegal address detection with reset
32-pin plastic LQFP package
Low-power design with stop and wait modes
Master reset pin and power-on reset (POR)
–40°C to 85°C and –40°C to 125°C operation
Features of the CPU08 include:
• Enhanced HC05 programming model
• Extensive loop control functions
• 16 addressing modes (eight more than the HC05)
• 16-bit index register and stack pointer
• Memory-to-memory data transfers
• Fast 8 × 8 multiply instruction
• Fast 16/8 divide instruction
• Binary-coded decimal (BCD) instructions
• Optimization for controller applications
• Third party C language support
1.3 MCU Block Diagram
Figure 1-1 shows the structure of the MC68HC908RF2A MCU.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
16
Freescale Semiconductor
MCU Block Diagram
INTERNAL BUS
M68HC08 CPU
CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 32 BYTES
PTA7(2)
PTA6/KBD6(2) (3)
PTA5/KBD5(2) (3)
SECURITY
MODULE
PTA
ARITHMETIC/LOGIC
UNIT (ALU)
DDRA
CPU
REGISTERS
COMPUTER OPERATING
PROPERLY MODULE
PTB
LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT
MODULE
DDRB
MONITOR ROM — 768 BYTES
PTA3/KBD3(2) (3)
PTA2/KBD2(2) (3)
PTA1/KBD1(2) (3)
PTA0(2)
USER FLASH — 2031 BYTES
USER RAM — 128 BYTES
PTA4/KBD4(2) (3)
2-CHANNEL TIMER
MODULE
PTB3/TCLK
PTB2/TCH0
PTB1
PTB0/MCLK
USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 14 BYTES
OSC2
OSC1
SOFTWARE SELECTABLE
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
MODULE
VCC
MODE
RST(1)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
IRQ(1)
KEYBOARD/INTERRUPT
MODULE
ENABLE
DATA
BAND
UHF
TRANSMITTER
RFOUT
GNDRF
REXT
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
XTAL1
XTAL0
DATACLK
VDD
CFSK
POWER
VSS
1. Pin contains integrated pullup resistor
2. High current sink pin
3. Pin contains software selectable pullup resistor
Figure 1-1. MC68HC908RF2A MCU Block Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
17
General Description
1.4 Pin Assignments
PTA2/KBD2
PTA3/KBD3
PTA4/KBD4
PTA5/KBD5
PTA6/KBD6
PTA7
RST
IRQ
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Figure 1-2 shows the pin assignments.
OSC1
PTB2/TCH0
5
20
PTB3/TCLK
GND
6
19
DATACLK
XTAL1
7
18
DATA
XTAL0
8
17
BAND
REXT
16
21
MODE
4
15
PTB1
ENABLE
OSC2
14
22
VCC
3
13
PTB0/MCLK
GNDRF
VSS
12
23
RFOUT
2
11
PTA0
VCC
VDD
10
24
CFSK
1
9
PTA1/KBD1
Figure 1-2. LQFP Pin Assignments
1.4.1 Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS)
VDD and VSS are the power supply and ground pins. The MCU operates from a single power supply.
Fast signal transitions on MCU pins place high, short-duration current demands on the power supply. To
prevent noise problems, take special care to provide power supply bypassing at the MCU as shown in
Figure 1-3. Place the bypass capacitors as close to the MCU power pins as possible. Use
high-frequency-response ceramic capacitors for CBypass. CBulk are optional bulk current bypass
capacitors for use in applications that require the port pins to source high-current levels.
MCU
VDD
VSS
CBypass
0.1 µF
+
CBulk
VDD
Note: Component values shown represent typical applications.
Figure 1-3. Power Supply Bypassing
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
18
Freescale Semiconductor
Pin Assignments
1.4.2 Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2)
The OSC1 and OSC2 pins are the connections to an external clock source or crystal/ceramic resonator.
1.4.3 External Reset (RST)
A logic 0 on the RST pin forces the MCU to a known startup state. RST is bidirectional, allowing a reset
of the entire system. It is driven low when any internal reset source is asserted.
The RST pin contains an internal pullup resistor.
For additional information, see Chapter 10 System Integration Module (SIM).
1.4.4 External Interrupt Pin (IRQ)
IRQ is an asynchronous external interrupt pin.
The IRQ pin contains an internal pullup resistor.
1.4.5 Port A Input/Output Pins (PTA7, PTA6/KBD6–PTA1/KBD1, and PTA0)
Port A is an 8-bit special function port that shares its pins with the keyboard interrupt.
Six port A pins (PTA6–PTA1) can be programmed to serve as an external interrupt. Once enabled, that
pin will contain an internal pullup resistor.
All port A pins are high-current sink pins.
1.4.6 Port B Input/Output Pins (PTB3/TCLK, PTB2/TCH0, PTB1, and PTB0/MCLK)
Port B is a 4-bit, general-purpose, bidirectional I/O port, with some of its pins shared with the timer (TIM)
module.
1.4.7 UHF Transmitter Pins
The MC68HC908RF2A uses dedicated pins for its UHF module. These pins are described in Table 1-1.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
19
General Description
Table 1-1. UHF Transmitter Pins
Pin
Function
Description
6
GND
7
XTAL1
Ground
Reference oscillator input
8
XTAL0
Reference oscillator output
9
REXT
Output amplifier current setting resistor
10
CFSK
FSK switch output
11
VCC
Power supply
12
RFOUT
Power amplifier output
13
GNDRF
Power amplifier ground
14
VCC
Power supply
15
ENABLE
Enable input
16
MODE
Modulation type selection input
17
BAND
Frequency band selection
18
DATA
Data input
19
DATACLK
Clock output to the microcontroller
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
20
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2
Memory
2.1 Introduction
The memory map, shown in Figure 2-1, includes:
• 2031 bytes of user FLASH memory
• 128 bytes of random-access memory (RAM)
• 14 bytes of user-defined vectors in FLASH memory
• 768 bytes of monitor read-only memory (ROM)
These definitions apply to the memory map representation of reserved and unimplemented locations:
• Reserved — Accessing a reserved location can have unpredictable effects on MCU operation.
• Unimplemented — Accessing an unimplemented location causes an illegal address reset.
2.2 Input/Output Section
Addresses $0000–$003F, shown in Figure 2-2, contain most of the control, status, and data registers.
Additional I/O registers have these addresses:
• $FE00 — SIM break status register, SBSR
• $FE01 — SIM reset status register, SRSR
• $FE02 — SIM break flag control register, BFCR
• $FE08 — FLASH control register, FLCR
• $FE0C — BREAK address register high, BRKH
• $FE0D — BREAK address register low, BRKL
• $FE0E — BREAK status and control register, BSCR
• $FE0F — LVI status register, LVISR
• $FFF0 — FLASH block protection register, FLBPR
• $FFFF — COP control register, COPCTL
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
21
Memory
$0000
↓
$003F
I/O REGISTERS
(28 BYTES)
$0040
↓
$007F
UNIMPLEMENTED
(64 BYTES)
$0080
↓
$00FF
RAM
(128 BYTES)
$0100
↓
$77FF
UNIMPLEMENTED
(30,464 BYTES)
$7800
↓
$7FEE
FLASH MEMORY
(2031 BYTES)
$7FEF
OPTIONAL FACTORY DETERMINED ICG TRIM VALUE(1)
$7FF0
↓
$EFFF
UNIMPLEMENTED
(28,688 BYTES)
$F000
↓
$F2EF
MONITOR ROM
(752 BYTES)
$F2F0
↓
$FDFF
UNIMPLEMENTED
(2832 BYTES)
$FE00
SIM BREAK STATUS REGISTER (SBSR)
$FE01
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER (SRSR)
$FE02
SIM BREAK FLAG CONTROL REGISTER (SBFCR)
$FE03
↓
$FE06
RESERVED
(4 BYTES)
$FE07
UNIMPLEMENTED (1 BYTE)
$FE08
FLASH CONTROL REGISTER (FLCR)
$FE09
RESERVED
$FE0A
↓
$FE0B
UNIMPLEMENTED (2 BYTES)
$FE0C
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH (BRKH)
$FE0D
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW (BRKL)
$FE0E
BREAK STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER (BSCR)
$FE0F
LVI STATUS REGISTER (LVISR)
$FE10
↓
$FEEF
UNIMPLEMENTED
(222 BYTES)
Continued on next page
Figure 2-1. Memory Map
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
22
Freescale Semiconductor
Input/Output Section
$FEF0
↓
$FEFF
MONITOR ROM
(16 BYTES)
$FF00
↓
$FFEF
UNIMPLEMENTED
(240 BYTES)
$FFF0
FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REGISTER (FLBPR)
$FFF1
RESERVED
$FFF2
↓
$FFFF
FLASH VECTORS
(14 BYTES)
1. Address $7FEF is reserved for an optional factory-determined
ICG trim value. Consult with a local Freescale representative for
more information and availability of this option.
Figure 2-1. Memory Map (Continued)
Addr.
Register Name
$0000
Port A Data Register Read:
(PTA) Write:
See page 98. Reset:
$0001
Port B Data Register Read:
(PTB) Write:
See page 100. Reset:
$0002
↓
$0003
Unimplemented
$0004
Data Direction Register A Read:
(DDRA) Write:
See page 98. Reset:
$0005
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTA7
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
Unaffected by reset
PTB3
Unaffected by reset
DDRA7
DDRA6
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
DDRA1
DDRA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRB3
DDRB2
DDRB1
DDRB0
0
0
0
0
KEYF
0
R
ACKK
IMASKK
MODEK
0
0
0
0
Data Direction Register B Read: MCLKEN
(DDRB) Write:
See page 100. Reset:
0
$0006
↓
$0019
Unimplemented
$001A
IRQ and Keyboard Status Read:
and Control Register Write:
(INTKBSCR)
See page 90. Reset:
0
0
IRQF
0
R
ACKI
0
0
0
0
IMASKI
MODEI
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved U = Unaffected X = Indeterminate
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 1 of 4)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
23
Memory
Addr.
$001B
$001C
↓
$001E
$001F
Register Name
Keyboard Interrupt Enable Read:
Register (INTKBIER) Write:
See page 91. Reset:
Bit 7
0
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
KBIE6
KBIE5
KBIE4
KBIE3
KBIE2
KBIE1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LVISTOP
LVIRST
LVIPWR
COPRS
SSREC
STOP
COPD
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
TOIE
TSTOP
0
0
PS2
PS1
PS0
0
Unimplemented
Configuration Register Read: EXTSLOW
(CONFIG) Write:
See page 41. Reset:
0
Timer Status and Control Read:
Register (TSC) Write:
See page 129. Reset:
TOF
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
$0021
Timer Counter Register High Read:
(TCNTH) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
$0022
Timer Counter Register Low Read:
(TCNTL) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
$0020
$0023
$0024
Timer Counter Modulo Read:
Register High (TMODH) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
Timer Counter Modulo Read:
Register Low (TMODL) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
$0025
Timer Channel 0 Status and Read:
Control Register (TSC0) Write:
See page 129. Reset:
$0026
Timer Channel 0 Register Read:
High (TCH0H) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
$0027
$0028
Timer Channel 0 Register Read:
Low (TCH0L) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
Timer Channel 1 Status and Read:
Control Register (TSC1) Write:
See page 129. Reset:
0
CH0F
0
TRST
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
CH1F
0
0
CH1IE
0
= Unimplemented
0
0
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved U = Unaffected X = Indeterminate
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 2 of 4)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
24
Freescale Semiconductor
Input/Output Section
Addr.
$0029
$002A
Register Name
Timer Channel 1 Register Read:
High (TCH1H) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
Timer Channel 1 Register Read:
Low (TCH1L) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
$002B
↓
$0035
Unimplemented
$0036
Internal Clock Generator Read:
Control Register (ICGCR) Write:
See page 78. Reset:
$0037
Internal Clock Generator Read:
Multiplier Register (ICGMR) Write:
See page 80. Reset:
$0038
Internal Clock Generator Read:
Trim Register (ICGTR) Write:
See page 80. Reset:
$0039
$003A
ICG DCO Divider Read:
Control Register (ICGDVR) Write:
See page 81. Reset:
ICG DCO Stage Register Read:
(ICGDSR) Write:
See page 81. Reset:
$003B
Reserved
$003C
↓
$003F
Unimplemented
$FE00
SIM Break Status Register Read:
(SBSR) Write:
See page 115. Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
CMIE
CMF
CMON
CS
ICGON
ICGS
ECGON
ECGS
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
R
N6
N5
N4
N3
N2
N1
N0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
TRIM7
TRIM6
TRIM5
TRIM4
TRIM3
TRIM2
TRIM1
TRIM0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
DDIV3
DDIV2
DDIV1
DDIV0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
U
DSTG7
DSTG6
DSTG5
DSTG4
DSTG3
DSTG2
DSTG1
DSTG0
R
R
Unaffected by reset
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
SBSW
See Note
R
0
Note: Writing a 0 clears SBSW
$FE01
SIM Reset Status Register Read:
(SRSR) Write:
See page 115. POR:
POR
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
0
LVI
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved U = Unaffected X = Indeterminate
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 3 of 4)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
25
Memory
Addr.
$FE02
Register Name
SIM Break Flag Control Read:
Register (SBFCR) Write:
See page 116. Reset:
$FE03
↓
$FE04
Reserved
$FE05
↓
$FE07
Unimplemented
$FE08
FLASH 2TS Control Read:
Register (FLCR) Write:
See page 29. Reset:
$FE09
Reserved
$FE0A
↓
$FE0B
Unimplemented
Break Address Register High Read:
$FE0C
(BRKH) Write:
See page 146. Reset:
$FE0D
$FE0E
Break Address Register Low Read:
(BRKL) Write:
See page 146. Reset:
Break Status and Control Read:
Register (BSCR) Write:
See page 145. Reset:
$FE0F
LVI Status Register Read:
(LVISR) Write:
See page 94. Reset:
$FFF0
FLASH 2TS Block Protect Read:
Register (FLBPR)† Write:
See page 33.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
FDIV0
BLK1
BLK0
HVEN
MARGIN
ERASE
PGM
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BRKE
BRKA
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LVIOUT
0
LOWV
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
BPR3
BPR2
BPR1
BPR0
0
Unaffected by reset
† Non-volatile FLASH register
$FFFF
COP Control Register Read:
(COPCTL) Write:
See page 45. Reset:
LOW BYTE OF RESET VECTOR
WRITING CLEARS COP COUNTER (ANY VALUE)
Unaffected by reset
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved U = Unaffected X = Indeterminate
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 4 of 4)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
26
Freescale Semiconductor
Monitor ROM
Table 2-1 is a list of vector locations.
Table 2-1. Vector Locations
High
Priority
Low
Address
Vector
$FFF2
ICG vector (high)
$FFF3
ICG vector (low)
$FFF4
TIM overflow vector (high)
$FFF5
TIM overflow vector (low)
$FFF6
TIM channel 1 vector (high)
$FFF7
TIM channel 1 vector (low)
$FFF8
TIM channel 0 vector (high)
$FFF9
TIM channel 0 vector (low)
$FFFA
IRQ/keyboard vector (high)
$FFFB
IRQ/keyboard vector (low)
$FFFC
SWI vector (high)
$FFFD
SWI vector (low)
$FFFE
Reset vector (high)
$FFFF
Reset vector (low)
2.3 Monitor ROM
The 768 bytes at addresses $F000–F2EF and $FEF0–$FEFF are utilized by the monitor ROM.
The address range $F000–F2EF is reserved for the monitor code functions, FLASH memory
programming, and erase algorithms.
The address range $FEF0–$FEFF holds reserved ROM addresses that contain the monitor code reset
vectors.
2.4 Random-Access Memory (RAM)
Addresses $0080–$00FF are RAM locations. The location of the stack RAM is programmable.
NOTE
For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM locations.
Before processing an interrupt, the CPU uses five bytes of the stack to save the contents of the CPU
registers.
NOTE
For M68HC05, M6805, and M146805 compatibility, the H register is not
stacked.
During a subroutine call, the CPU uses two bytes of the stack to store the return address. The stack
pointer decrements during pushes and increments during pulls.
NOTE
Be careful when using nested subroutines. The CPU could overwrite data
in the RAM during a subroutine or during the interrupt stacking operation.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
27
Memory
2.5 FLASH 2TS Memory
This section describes the operation of the embedded FLASH 2TS memory. This memory can be read,
programmed, and erased from a single external supply. The program and erase operations are enabled
through the use of an internal charge pump.
The FLASH 2TS memory is appropriately named to describe its 2-transistor source-select bit cell. The
FLASH 2TS memory is an array of 2031 bytes with an additional 14 bytes of user vectors and one byte
for block protection. An erased bit reads as a 0 and a programmed bit reads as a 1.
The address ranges for the user memory, control register, and vectors are:
•
$7800–$7FEE, user space
•
$7FEF, reserved — optional ICG trim value, see 6.7.3 ICG Trim Register
•
$FFF0, block protect register
•
$FE08, FLASH 2TS control register
•
$FFF2–$FFFF, these locations are reserved for user-defined interrupt and reset vectors
This list is the row architecture for the user space array:
$7800–$7807 (Row 0)
$7808–$780F (Row 1)
$7810–$7817 (Row 2)
$7818–$781F (Row 3)
$7820–$7827 (Row 4)
-----------------------------------$7FE8–$7FEF (Row 253)
Program and erase operations are facilitated through control bits in a memory mapped register. Details
for these operations appear later in this section. Memory in the FLASH 2TS array is organized into pages
within rows. For the 2-Kbyte array on the MC68HC908RF2A, the page size is one byte. There are eight
pages (or eight bytes) per row. Programming operations are performed on a page basis, one byte at a
time. Erase operations are performed on a block basis. The minimum block size is one row of eight bytes.
Refer to Table 2-3 for additional block size options.
NOTE
Sometimes a program disturb condition, in which case an erased bit on the
row being programmed unintentionally becomes programmed, occurs. The
embedded smart programming algorithm implements a margin read
technique to avoid program disturb. The margin read step of the smart
programming algorithm is used to ensure programmed bits are
programmed to sufficient margin for data retention over the device’s
lifetime. In the application code, perform an erase operation after eight
program operations (on the same row) to further avoid program disturb.
For availability of programming tools and more information, contact a local Freescale representative.
NOTE
A security feature prevents viewing of the FLASH 2TS contents.(1)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
28
Freescale Semiconductor
FLASH 2TS Memory
2.5.1 FLASH 2TS Control Register
The FLASH 2TS control register (FLCR) controls program, erase, and margin read operations.
Address: $FE08
Bit 7
Read:
0
Write:
Reset:
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FDIV0
BLK1
BLK0
HVEN
MARGIN
ERASE
PGM
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-3. FLASH 2TS Control Register (FLCR)
FDIV0 — Frequency Divide Control Bit
This read/write bit selects the factor by which the charge pump clock is divided from the system clock.
See 2.5.2 FLASH 2TS Charge Pump Frequency Control.
BLK1 — Block Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit together with BLK0 allows erasing of blocks of varying size. See 2.5.3 FLASH 2TS
Erase Operation for a description of available block sizes.
BLK0 — Block Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit together with BLK1 allows erasing of blocks of varying size. See 2.5.3 FLASH 2TS
Erase Operation for a description of available block sizes.
HVEN — High-Voltage Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the charge pump to drive high voltages for program and erase operations
in the array. HVEN can be set only if either PGM = 1 or ERASE = 1 and the proper sequence for smart
programming or erase is followed.
1 = High voltage enabled to array and charge pump on
0 = High voltage disabled to array and charge pump off
MARGIN — Margin Read Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for margin read operation. MARGIN cannot be set if the
HVEN = 1. MARGIN will automatically return to unset (0) if asserted when HVEN = 1.
1 = Margin read operation selected
0 = Margin read operation unselected
ERASE — Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for erase operation. ERASE is interlocked with the PGM bit
such that both bits cannot be set at the same time.
1 = Erase operation selected
0 = Erase operation unselected
PGM — Program Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for program operation. PGM is interlocked with the ERASE
bit such that both bits cannot be set at the same time.
1 = Program operation selected
0 = Program operation unselected
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Freescale’s strategy is to make reading or copying the FLASH 2TS difficult
for unauthorized users.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
29
Memory
2.5.2 FLASH 2TS Charge Pump Frequency Control
The internal charge pump, required for program, margin read, and erase operations, is designed to
operate most efficiently with a 2-MHz clock. The charge pump clock is derived from the bus clock.
Table 2-2 shows how the FDIV bits are used to select a charge pump frequency based on the bus clock
frequency. Program, margin read, and erase operations cannot be performed if the bus clock frequency
is below 2 MHz.
Table 2-2. Charge Pump Clock Frequency
FDIV0
Pump Clock Frequency
0
Bus frequency ÷ 1
1
Bus frequency ÷ 2
NOTE
The charge pump is optimized for 2-MHz operation.
2.5.3 FLASH 2TS Erase Operation
Use this step-by-step procedure to erase a block of FLASH 2TS memory. Refer to 14.12 Memory
Characteristics for a detailed description of the times used in this algorithm.
1. Set the ERASE, BLK0, BLK1, and FDIV0 bits in the FLASH 2TS control register. Refer to Table 2-2
for FDIV settings and to Table 2-3 for block sizes.
2. Ensure target portion of array is unprotected by reading the block protect register at address
$FFF0. Refer to 2.5.5 FLASH 2TS Block Protection and 2.5.6 FLASH 2TS Block Protect Register
for more information.
3. Write to any FLASH 2TS address with any data within the block address range desired.
4. Set the HVEN bit.
5. Wait for a time, tErase.
6. Clear the HVEN bit.
7. Wait for a time, tKill, for the high voltages to dissipate.
8. Clear the ERASE bit.
9. After a time, tHVD, the memory can be accessed in read mode again.
NOTE
While these operations must be performed in the order shown, other
unrelated operations may occur between the steps.
Table 2-3 shows the various block sizes which can be erased in one erase operation.
Table 2-3. Erase Block Sizes
BLK1
BLK0
Block Size, Addresses Cared
0
0
Full array: 2 Kbytes
0
1
One-half array: 1 Kbyte
1
0
Eight rows: 64 bytes
1
1
Single row: 8 bytes
In step 3 of the erase operation, the cared addresses are latched and used to determine the location of
the block to be erased. For instance, with BLK0 = BLK1 = 0, writing to any FLASH 2TS address in the
range $7800 to $78F0 will enable the erase of all FLASH memory.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
30
Freescale Semiconductor
FLASH 2TS Memory
2.5.4 FLASH 2TS Program/Margin Read Operation
NOTE
After a total of eight program operations have been applied to a row, the row
must be erased before further programming to avoid program disturb. An
erased byte will read $00.
The FLASH 2TS memory is programmed on a page basis. A page consists of one byte. The smart
programming algorithm (Figure 2-4) is recommended to program every page in the FLASH 2TS memory.
The embedded smart programming algorithm uses this step-by-step sequence to program the data into
the FLASH memory. The algorithm optimizes the time required to program each page. Refer to 2.5.7
Embedded Program/Erase Routines for information on utilizing embedded routines.
1. Set the FDIV bits. These bits determine the charge pump frequency.
2. Set PGM = 1. This configures the memory for program operation and enables the latching of
address and data for programming.
3. Read the FLASH 2TS block protect register (FLBPR).
4. Write data to the one byte being programmed.
5. Set HVEN = 1.
6. Wait for a time, tStep.
7. Set HVEN = 0.
8. Wait for a time, tHVTV.
9. Set MARGIN = 1.
10. Wait for a time, tVTP.
11. Set PGM = 0.
12. Wait for a time, tHVD.
13. Read back data in margin read mode. This read operation is stretched by eight cycles.
14. Clear the MARGIN bit. If the margin read data is identical to
write data, the program operation is complete; otherwise, jump to step 2.
NOTE
While these operations must be performed in the order shown, other
unrelated operations may occur between the steps.
The smart programming algorithm guarantees the minimum possible program time.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
31
Memory
PROGRAM FLASH 2TS
Page Program/Margin Read Procedure
Note: This algorithm is mandatory for
programming the FLASH 2TS.
SET INTERRUPT MASK:
SEI INSTRUCTION
Note: This page program algorithm
assumes the page/s to be programmed
are initially erased.
INITIALIZE ATTEMPT COUNTER
TO 0
SET PGM BIT AND FDIV BITS
READ FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REG.
WRITE DATA TO
SELECTED PAGE
SET HVEN BIT
WAIT tSTEP
CLEAR HVEN BIT
WAIT THVTV
SET MARGIN BIT
WAIT tVTP
CLEAR PGM BIT
WAIT tHVD
MARGIN READ PAGE OF DATA
CLEAR MARGIN BIT
N
INCREMENT ATTEMPT COUNTER
MARGIN READ DATA
EQUAL TO
WRITE DATA?
Y
N
CLEAR MARGIN BIT
ATTEMPT COUNT
EQUAL TO
flsPulses?
CLEAR INTERRUPT MASK:
CLI INSTRUCTION
Y
PROGRAMMING OPERATION
FAILED
PROGRAMMING OPERATION
COMPLETE
Figure 2-4. Smart Programming Algorithm Flowchart
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
32
Freescale Semiconductor
FLASH 2TS Memory
2.5.5 FLASH 2TS Block Protection
NOTE
In performing a program or erase operation, the FLASH 2TS block protect
register must be read after setting the PGM or ERASE bit and before
asserting the HVEN bit.
Due to the ability of the on-board charge pump to erase and program the FLASH 2TS memory in the target
application, provision is made for protecting blocks of memory from unintentional erase or program
operations due to system malfunction. This protection is implemented by a reserved location in the
memory for block protect information. This block protect register must be read before setting HVEN = 1.
When the block protect register is read, its contents are latched by the FLASH 2TS control logic. If the
address range for an erase or program operation includes a protected block, the PGM or ERASE bit is
cleared which prevents the HVEN bit in the FLASH 2TS control register from being set such that no
high-voltage operation is allowed in the array.
When the block protect register is erased (all 0s), the entire memory is accessible for program and erase.
When bits within the register are programmed, they lock blocks of memory address ranges as shown in
2.5.6 FLASH 2TS Block Protect Register. The block protect register itself can be erased or programmed
only with an external voltage VTST present on the IRQ pin. The presence of VTST on the IRQ pin also
allows entry into monitor mode out of reset. Therefore, the ability to change the block protect register is
voltage-level dependent and can occur in either user or monitor modes.
2.5.6 FLASH 2TS Block Protect Register
The block protect register (FLBPR) is implemented as a byte within the FLASH 2TS memory. Each bit,
when programmed, protects a range of addresses in the FLASH 2TS.
Address: $FFF0
Read:
Write:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
BPR3
BPR2
BPR1
BPR0
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-5. FLASH 2TS Block Protect Register (FLBPR)
BPR3 — Block Protect Register Bit 3
This bit protects the memory contents in the address ranges $7A00–$7FEF and $FFF0–$FFFF.
1 = Address range protected from erase or program
0 = Address range open to erase or program
BPR2 — Block Protect Register Bit 2
This bit protects the memory contents in the address ranges $7900–$7FEF and $FFF0–$FFFF.
1 = Address range protected from erase or program
0 = Address range open to erase or program
BPR1 — Block Protect Register Bit 1
This bit protects the memory contents in the address ranges $7880–$7FEF and $FFF0–$FFFF.
1 = Address range protected from erase or program
0 = Address range open to erase or program
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
33
Memory
BPR0 — Block Protect Register Bit 0
This bit protects the FLASH memory contents in the address ranges $7800–$7FEF and
$FFF0–$FFFF.
1 = Address range protected from erase or program
0 = Address range open to erase or program
By programming the block protect bits, a portion of the memory will be locked so that no further erase or
program operations may be performed. Programming more than one bit at a time is redundant. If both bit
1 and bit 2 are set, for instance, the FLASH address ranges between $7880–$FFFF are locked. If all bits
are erased, then all of the memory is available for erase and program.
The presence of a voltage VTST on the IRQ pin will bypass the block protection so that all of memory,
including the block protect register, can be programmed or erased.
2.5.7 Embedded Program/Erase Routines
The MC68HC908RF2A monitor ROM contains numerous routines for programming and erasing the
FLASH memory. These embedded routines are intended to assist the programmer with modifying the
FLASH memory array. These routines will implement the smart programming algorithm as defined in
Figure 2-4. The functions are listed in Table 2-4
.
Table 2-4. Embedded FLASH Routines
Call
JSR to Address(1)
Read/verify a range
RDVRRNG
ROMSTRT + 0
Program range of FLASH
PRGRNGE
ROMSTRT + 3
Erase range of FLASH
ERARNGE
ROMSTRT + 6
Redundant program FLASH
REDPROG
ROMSTRT + 9
Function Description
1. ROMSTRT is defined as the starting address of the monitor ROM in the
memory map. This is address $F000.
The functions shown in Table 2-4 accept data through the CPU registers and global variables in RAM.
Table 2-5 shows the RAM locations that are used for passing parameters.
Table 2-5. Embedded FLASH Routine Global Variables
Variable Location
Variable Address(1)
CTRLBYT
RAMSTART + 8
CPUSPD
RAMSTART + 9
LADDR
RAMSTART + 10
BUMPS
RAMSTART + 12
DERASE
RAMSTART + 13
DATA
RAMSTART + 15
1. RAMSTART is defined as the starting address of the RAM in the memory map.
This is address $0080.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
34
Freescale Semiconductor
FLASH 2TS Memory
2.5.8 Embedded Function Descriptions
This subsection describes the embedded functions.
2.5.8.1 RDVRRNG Routine
Name:
Purpose:
Entry conditions:
Exit conditions:
Ready/verify
RAM option:
Output to PA0 option:
RDVRRNG
Read and/or verify a range of FLASH memory
H:X
Contains the first address of the range
LADDR
Contains the last address of the range
DATA
Contains the data to compare the read data against for read/verify
to RAM only (length is user determined)
ACC
Non-zero for read/verify to RAM, 0 for output to PA0
C bit
Set if good compare for read/verify to RAM only
ACC
Contains checksum
DATA
Contains read FLASH data for read/verify to RAM only
This subroutine both compares data passed in the DATA array to the FLASH
data and reads the data from FLASH into the DATA array. It also calculates the
checksum of the data.
This subroutine dumps the data from the range to PA0 in the same format as
monitor data. It also calculates the checksum of the data.
NOTE
This serial dump does not circumvent security because the security vectors
must still be passed to make FLASH readable in monitor mode.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
35
Memory
2.5.8.2 PRGRNGE Routine
Name:
Purpose:
Entry conditions:
Exit conditions:
PRGRNGE
Programs a range of addresses in FLASH memory
H:X
Contains the first address in the range
LADDR
Contains the last address in the range
DATA
Contains the data to be programmed (length is user determined)
CPUSPD
Contains the bus frequency times 4 in MHz
BUMPS
Contains the maximum allowable number of programming bumps to
use
C bit
Set if successful program; cleared otherwise
I bit
Set, masking interrupts
This routine programs a range of FLASH defined by H:X and LADDR. The range
can be from one byte to as much RAM as can be allocated to DATA. The smart
programming algorithm defined in 2.5.4 FLASH 2TS Program/Margin Read
Operation is used.
2.5.8.3 ERARNGE Routine
Name:
Purpose:
Entry conditions:
ERARNGE
Erase a range of addresses in FLASH memory
H:X
Contains an address in the range to be erased; range size specified
by control byte
CTLBYTE Contains the erase block size in bits 5 and 6 (see Table 2-6)
DERASE
Contains the erase delay time in µs/24
CPUSPD
CPU frequency times 4 in MHz
Table 2-6. CTLBYTE-Erase Block Size
Exit conditions:
I bit
Bit 6
Bit 5
Block Size
0
0
Full array
0
1
One half array
1
0
Eight rows: 64 pages
1
1
Single row: 8 pages
Set, masking interrupts.
This routine erases the block of FLASH defined by H:X and CTLBYTE. The
algorithm defined in 2.5.3 FLASH 2TS Erase Operation is used.
Preserves the contents of H:X (address passed)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
36
Freescale Semiconductor
FLASH 2TS Memory
2.5.8.4 REDPROG Routine
Name:
Purpose:
Entry conditions:
Exit conditions:
REDPROG
This routine will use a range of multiple rows in the FLASH array to emulate
increased write/erase cycling capability of one row.
H:X
Contains the address of the first row in the range. This address must
be the first address of a row (multiple of eight bytes)
LADDR
Address of last row in the range; must be the first address of a row
(multiple of eight bytes)
DATA
Data to program in the row (bit 7 of DATA + 0 is used internally and
will be overwritten). Routine will always use 8 bytes starting at
DATA
BUMPS
Contains the maximum allowable number of programming bumps to
use
CPUSPD
Contains the bus frequency times 4 in MHz
DERASE
Contains the erase delay time in µs/24
C bit
Set if successful program; cleared otherwise
I bit
Set, masking interrupts
This routine uses a range of the FLASH array containing multiple rows to
emulate increased write/erase cycling capability for data storage. The routine
will write data to each row of the FLASH array (in the range defined) upon
subsequent calls. The number of rows is the difference between the value in H:X
and LADDR, divided by 8.
A row is the minimum range that can be programmed with the REDPROG
routine. All rows in the range will be programmed once before any are
programmed again. This approach is taken to ensure that all rows reach the end
of lifetime at approximately the same time.
A special bit will be maintained by the routine, called a cycling bit, in each row.
This bit is used to ensure that the data is programmed to all the rows defined in
the range. This is the high bit of the first byte in each row. This bit cannot be used
to store user data. It will be modified by the REDPROG routine. This is at bit 7
of the byte at address DATA+0.
To determine which row to program, the algorithm will step from the first to the
last row in a range looking for the first row whose cycling bit is different from the
first. If all rows contain the same cycling bit, then the first row will be used.
The row whose cycling bit is different will be erased and the entire row will be
programmed with the given data, including a toggled version of the cycling bit.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
37
Memory
2.5.8.5 Example Routine Calls
This code is for illustrative purposes only and does not represent valid syntax for any particular assembler.
RAM
EQU
$80
RDVRRNG EQU
$F000
PRGRNGE EQU
$F003
ERANRGE EQU
$F006
REDPROG EQU
$F009
;*************************************************************
RAM Definitions for Subroutines
;**************************************************************
ORG
RAM+8
CTRLBYT
CPUSPD
LADDR
BUMPS
DERASE
RMB
RMB
RMB
RMB
RMB
1
1
2
1
2
;Allocation of “DATA” space is dependent on the device and ;application
DATARMB
8
;*************************************************************
; CALLING EXAMPLE FOR READ/VERIFY A RANGE (RDVRRNG)
;**************************************************************
LDA#$FF
;TARGET IS RAM
LDHX
#$7807
;END AFTER FIRST ROW
STHX
LADDR
LDHX
#$7800
;START AT FIRST ROW
JSR
RDVRRNG ;DATA WILL CONTAIN FLASH INFO
;*************************************************************
; CALLING EXAMPLE FOR ERASE A RANGE (RNGEERA)
;**************************************************************
MOV#$08,CPUSPD
;Load Bus frequency in MHz * 4
MOV#$60,CTRLBYT ;Bits 5&6 hold the block size to erase
;00 Full Array
;20 One-Half Array
;40 Eight Rows
;60 Singe Row
;Remember a Row is 1 byte
;Set erase time in uS/24, number in
;decimal
LDHX#100000/24
STHXDERASE
LDHX#$7800
JSRERARNGE
;Address in the range to erase
;Call through jump table
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
38
Freescale Semiconductor
FLASH 2TS Memory
;************************************************************;
; CALLING EXAMPLE FOR PROGRAM A RANGE (RNGEPROG)
;*************************************************************
MOV#’P’,DATA
MOV#’R’,DATA+1
MOV#’O’,DATA+2
MOV#’G’,DATA+3
MOV#’T’,DATA+4
MOV#’E’,DATA+5
MOV#’S’,DATA+6
MOV#’T’,DATA+7
MOV#$08,CPUSPD
MOV#$0A,BUMPS
;Load Bus frequency in MHz * 4
;Load max number of programming steps
;before a failure is returned
LDHX
#$7807
;Load the last address to program
STHX
LADDR
;into LADDR
LDHX#$7800
;Load the first address to program
;into H:X
;This range may cross page boundaries
;and may be any length, so long as the
;data to program is loaded in RAM
;beginning at DATA.
JSRPRGRNGE
;Call through jump table.
;**************************************************************
; CALLING EXAMPLE FOR REDUNDANT PROGRAM A ROW (REDPROG)
;**************************************************************
MOV#$56,DATA
MOV#’P’,DATA+1
MOV#’R’,DATA+2
MOV#’O’,DATA+3
MOV#’G’,DATA+4
MOV#’R’,DATA+5
MOV#’E’,DATA+6
MOV#’D’,DATA+7
MOV#$08,CPUSPD
MOV#$0A,BUMPS
;Load Bus frequency in MHz * 4
;Load max number of programming steps
;before a failure is returned
;Set erase time in uS/24
LDHX#100000/24
STHXDERASE
LDHX
#$7808
STHX
LADDR
LDHX#$7800
JSRREDPROG
;Load the last address of the multi-row
;range; (in this case, 2 rows)
;into LADDR
;Load the first address of the
;multi-row range into H:X
;Call through jump table.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
39
Memory
2.5.9 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
2.5.9.1 Wait Mode
Putting the MCU into wait mode while the FLASH 2TS is in read mode does not affect the operation of
the FLASH 2TS memory directly, but there will be no memory activity since the CPU is inactive.
The WAIT instruction should not be executed while performing a program or erase operation on the
FLASH 2TS. When the MCU is put into wait mode, the charge pump for the FLASH 2TS is disabled so
that either a program or erase operation will not continue. If the memory is in either program mode
(PGM = 1, HVEN = 1) or erase mode (ERASE = 1, HVEN= 1), then it will remain in that mode during wait.
Exit from wait mode must now be done with a reset rather than an interrupt because if exiting wait with
an interrupt, the memory will not be in read mode and the interrupt vector cannot be read from the
memory.
2.5.9.2 Stop Mode
When the MCU is put into stop mode, if the FLASH 2TS is in read mode, it will be put into low-power
standby.
The STOP instruction should not be executed while performing a program or erase operation on the
FLASH 2TS. When the MCU is put into stop mode, the charge pump for the FLASH 2TS is disabled so
that either a program or erase operation will not continue. If the memory is in either program mode (PGM
= 1, HVEN = 1) or erase mode (ERASE = 1, HVEN = 1), then it will remain in that mode during stop. Exit
from stop mode now must be done with a reset rather than an interrupt because if exiting stop with an
interrupt, the memory will not be in read mode and the interrupt vector cannot be read from the memory.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
40
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 3
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
3.1 Introduction
This section describes the configuration register (CONFIG). The configuration register enables or
disables these options:
• Stop mode recovery time (32 CGMXCLK cycles or 4,096 CGMXCLK cycles)
• COP timeout period (218 – 24 or 213 – 24 CGMXCLK cycles)
• STOP instruction
• Computer operating properly module (COP)
• Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module control
3.2 Functional Description
The CONFIG register is used in the initialization of various options and can be written once after each
reset. The register is set to the documented value during reset. Since the various options affect the
operation of the MCU, it is recommended that these registers be written immediately after reset. The
configuration register is located at $001F.
NOTE
On a FLASH device, the options are one-time writable by the user after
each reset. The CONFIG register is not in the FLASH memory but is a
special register containing one-time writable latches after each reset. Upon
a reset, the CONFIG register defaults to predetermined settings as shown
in Figure 2-1. Memory Map.
Address: $001F
Read:
Write:
BIt 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EXTSLOW
LVISTOP
LVIRST
LVIPWR
COPRS
SSREC
STOP
COPD
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
Reset:
Figure 3-1. Configuration Register (CONFIG)
EXTSLOW — Slow External Crystal Enable Bit
The EXTSLOW bit has two functions. It configures the ICG module for a fast (1 MHz–8 MHz) or slow
(30 kHz–100 kHz) speed crystal. The option also configures the clock monitor operation in the ICG
module to expect an external frequency higher (307.2 kHz–32 MHz) or lower (60 Hz–307.2 kHz) than
the base frequency of the internal oscillator. (See Chapter 6 Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG).)
1 = ICG set for slow external crystal operation
0 = ICG set for fast external crystal operation
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
41
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
LVISTOP — LVI Enable in Stop Mode Bit
When the LVIPWR bit is set, setting the LVISTOP bit enables the LVI to operate during stop mode.
Reset clears LVISTOP.
1 = LVI enabled during stop mode
0 = LVI disabled during stop mode
LVIRST — LVI Reset Enable Bit
LVIRST enables the reset signal from the LVI module. (See Chapter 8 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).)
1 = LVI module resets enabled
0 = LVI module resets disabled
LVIPWR — LVI Power Enable Bit
LVIPWR disables the LVI module. (See Chapter 8 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).)
1 = LVI module power enabled
0 = LVI module power disabled
COPRS — COP Rate Select Bit
COPRS selects the COP timeout period. Reset clears COPRS. (See Chapter 4 Computer Operating
Properly Module (COP).)
1 = COP timeout period = 213 – 24 CGMXCLK cycles
0 = COP timeout period = 218 – 24 CGMXCLK cycles
SSREC — Short Stop Recovery Bit
SSREC enables the CPU to exit stop mode with a delay of 32 CGMXCLK cycles instead of a
4096-CGMXCLK cycle delay.
1 = Stop mode recovery after 32 CGMXCLK cycles
0 = Stop mode recovery after 4096 CGMXCLK cycles
NOTE
Exiting stop mode by pulling reset will result in the long stop recovery.
If using the internal clock generator module or an external crystal oscillator,
do not set the SSREC bit.
The LVI has an enable time of tEN. The system stabilization time for
power-on reset and long stop recovery (both 4096 CGMXCLK cycles) gives
a delay longer than the LVI enable time for these startup scenarios. There
is no period where the MCU is not protected from a low-power condition.
However, when using the short stop recovery configuration option, the 32
CGMXCLK delay must be greater than the LVI’s turn on time to avoid a
period in startup where the LVI is not protecting the MCU.
STOP — STOP Instruction Enable Bit
STOP enables the STOP instruction.
1 = STOP instruction enabled
0 = STOP instruction treated as illegal opcode
COPD — COP Disable Bit
COPD disables the COP module. (See Chapter 4 Computer Operating Properly Module (COP).)
1 = COP module disabled
0 = COP module enabled
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
42
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4
Computer Operating Properly Module (COP)
4.1 Introduction
The computer operating properly (COP) module contains a free-running counter that generates a reset if
allowed to overflow. The COP module helps software recover from runaway code. Prevent a COP reset
by periodically clearing the COP counter.
4.2 Functional Description
CLEAR STAGES 5–12
STOP INSTRUCTION
INTERNAL RESET SOURCES
RESET VECTOR FETCH
12-BIT COP PRESCALER
CLEAR ALL STAGES
CGMXCLK
COPCTL WRITE
RESET
RESET STATUS
REGISTER
COPD FROM CONFIG
RESET
COPCTL WRITE
6-BIT COP COUNTER
CLEAR COP
COUNTER
COPRS FROM CONFIG
Figure 4-1. COP Block Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
43
Computer Operating Properly Module (COP)
The COP counter is a free-running 6-bit counter preceded by a 12-bit prescaler. If not cleared by software,
the COP counter overflows and generates an asynchronous reset after 213 – 24 or 218 – 24 CGMXCLK
cycles, depending on the state of the COP rate select bit, COPRS, in the configuration register. When
COPRS = 1, a 4.9152-MHz crystal gives a COP timeout period of 53.3 ms. Writing any value to location
$FFFF before an overflow occurs prevents a COP reset by clearing the COP counter and stages 5
through 12 of the prescaler.
NOTE
Service the COP immediately after reset and before entering or after exiting
stop mode to guarantee the maximum time before the first COP counter
overflow.
A COP reset pulls the RST pin low for 32 CGMXCLK cycles and sets the COP bit in the SIM reset status
register (SRSR).
In monitor mode, the COP is disabled if the RST pin or the IRQ pin is held at VTST. During the break state,
VTST on the RST pin disables the COP.
NOTE
Place COP clearing instructions in the main program and not in an interrupt
subroutine. Such an interrupt subroutine could keep the COP from
generating a reset even while the main program is not working properly.
4.3 I/O Signals
The following paragraphs describe the signals shown in Figure 4-1.
4.3.1 CGMXCLK
CGMXCLK is the oscillator output signal. See 6.3.5 Clock Selection Circuit for a description of CGMXCLK.
4.3.2 STOP Instruction
The STOP instruction clears the COP prescaler.
4.3.3 COPCTL Write
Writing any value to the COP control register (COPCTL) (see 4.4 COP Control Register) clears the COP
counter and clears stages 12 through 5 of the COP prescaler. Reading the COP control register returns
the reset vector.
4.3.4 Power-On Reset
The power-on reset (POR) circuit clears the COP prescaler 4096 CGMXCLK cycles after power-up.
4.3.5 Internal Reset
An internal reset clears the COP prescaler and the COP counter.
4.3.6 Reset Vector Fetch
A reset vector fetch occurs when the vector address appears on the data bus. A reset vector fetch clears
the COP prescaler.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
44
Freescale Semiconductor
COP Control Register
4.3.7 COPD
The COPD signal reflects the state of the COP disable bit (COPD) in the configuration register. (See
Chapter 3 Configuration Register (CONFIG)).
4.3.8 COPRS
The COPRS signal reflects the state of the COP rate select bit (COPRS) in the configuration register. (See
Chapter 3 Configuration Register (CONFIG)).
4.4 COP Control Register
The COP control register is located at address $FFFF and overlaps the reset vector. Writing any value to
$FFFF clears the COP counter and starts a new timeout period. Reading location $FFFF returns the low
byte of the reset vector.
Address: $FFFF
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Read:
LOW BYTE OF RESET VECTOR
Write:
CLEAR COP COUNTER
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
2
1
Bit 0
Figure 4-2. COP Control Register (COPCTL)
4.5 Interrupts
The COP does not generate CPU interrupt requests.
4.6 Monitor Mode
The COP is disabled in monitor mode when VTST is present on the IRQ pin or on the RST pin.
4.7 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
4.7.1 Wait Mode
The COP remains active in wait mode. To prevent a COP reset during wait mode, periodically clear the
COP counter in a CPU interrupt routine.
4.7.2 Stop Mode
Stop mode turns off the CGMXCLK input to the COP and clears the COP prescaler. Service the COP
immediately before entering or after exiting stop mode to ensure a full COP timeout period after entering
or exiting stop mode.
The STOP bit (see Chapter 3 Configuration Register (CONFIG)) enables the STOP instruction. To
prevent inadvertently turning off the COP with a STOP instruction, disable the STOP instruction by
clearing the STOP bit.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
45
Computer Operating Properly Module (COP)
4.8 COP Module During Break Interrupts
The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VTST is present on the RST pin.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
46
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 5
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
5.1 Contents
The M68HC08 CPU (central processor unit) is an enhanced and fully object-code-compatible version of
the M68HC05 CPU. The CPU08 Reference Manual (document order number CPU08RM/AD) contains a
description of the CPU instruction set, addressing modes, and architecture.
5.2 Features
Features of the CPU include:
• Object code fully upward-compatible with M68HC05 Family
• 16-bit stack pointer with stack manipulation instructions
• 16-bit index register with x-register manipulation instructions
• 8-MHz CPU internal bus frequency
• 64-Kbyte program/data memory space
• 16 addressing modes
• Memory-to-memory data moves without using accumulator
• Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions
• Enhanced binary-coded decimal (BCD) data handling
• Modular architecture with expandable internal bus definition for extension of addressing range
beyond 64 Kbytes
• Low-power stop and wait modes
5.3 CPU Registers
Figure 5-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of the memory map.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
47
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
0
7
ACCUMULATOR (A)
0
15
H
X
INDEX REGISTER (H:X)
15
0
STACK POINTER (SP)
15
0
PROGRAM COUNTER (PC)
7
0
V 1 1 H I N Z C
CONDITION CODE REGISTER (CCR)
CARRY/BORROW FLAG
ZERO FLAG
NEGATIVE FLAG
INTERRUPT MASK
HALF-CARRY FLAG
TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW FLAG
Figure 5-1. CPU Registers
5.3.1 Accumulator
The accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. The CPU uses the accumulator to hold operands and
the results of arithmetic/logic operations.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 5-2. Accumulator (A)
5.3.2 Index Register
The 16-bit index register allows indexed addressing of a 64-Kbyte memory space. H is the upper byte of
the index register, and X is the lower byte. H:X is the concatenated 16-bit index register.
In the indexed addressing modes, the CPU uses the contents of the index register to determine the
conditional address of the operand.
The index register can serve also as a temporary data storage location.
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Read:
Write:
Reset:
X = Indeterminate
Figure 5-3. Index Register (H:X)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
48
Freescale Semiconductor
CPU Registers
5.3.3 Stack Pointer
The stack pointer is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next location on the stack. During a
reset, the stack pointer is preset to $00FF. The reset stack pointer (RSP) instruction sets the least
significant byte to $FF and does not affect the most significant byte. The stack pointer decrements as data
is pushed onto the stack and increments as data is pulled from the stack.
In the stack pointer 8-bit offset and 16-bit offset addressing modes, the stack pointer can function as an
index register to access data on the stack. The CPU uses the contents of the stack pointer to determine
the conditional address of the operand.
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 5-4. Stack Pointer (SP)
NOTE
The location of the stack is arbitrary and may be relocated anywhere in
random-access memory (RAM). Moving the SP out of page 0 ($0000 to
$00FF) frees direct address (page 0) space. For correct operation, the
stack pointer must point only to RAM locations.
5.3.4 Program Counter
The program counter is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next instruction or operand to be
fetched.
Normally, the program counter automatically increments to the next sequential memory location every
time an instruction or operand is fetched. Jump, branch, and interrupt operations load the program
counter with an address other than that of the next sequential location.
During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector address located at $FFFE and $FFFF.
The vector address is the address of the first instruction to be executed after exiting the reset state.
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Loaded with vector from $FFFE and $FFFF
Figure 5-5. Program Counter (PC)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
49
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
5.3.5 Condition Code Register
The 8-bit condition code register contains the interrupt mask and five flags that indicate the results of the
instruction just executed. Bits 6 and 5 are set permanently to 1. The following paragraphs describe the
functions of the condition code register.
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
V
1
1
H
I
N
Z
C
X
1
1
X
1
X
X
X
X = Indeterminate
Figure 5-6. Condition Code Register (CCR)
V — Overflow Flag
The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two's complement overflow occurs. The signed branch
instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use the overflow flag.
1 = Overflow
0 = No overflow
H — Half-Carry Flag
The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between accumulator bits 3 and 4 during an
add-without-carry (ADD) or add-with-carry (ADC) operation. The half-carry flag is required for
binary-coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic operations. The DAA instruction uses the states of the H and
C flags to determine the appropriate correction factor.
1 = Carry between bits 3 and 4
0 = No carry between bits 3 and 4
I — Interrupt Mask
When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are disabled. CPU interrupts are enabled
when the interrupt mask is cleared. When a CPU interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set
automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but before the interrupt vector is fetched.
1 = Interrupts disabled
0 = Interrupts enabled
NOTE
To maintain M6805 Family compatibility, the upper byte of the index
register (H) is not stacked automatically. If the interrupt service routine
modifies H, then the user must stack and unstack H using the PSHH and
PULH instructions.
After the I bit is cleared, the highest-priority interrupt request is serviced first.
A return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction pulls the CPU registers from the stack and restores the
interrupt mask from the stack. After any reset, the interrupt mask is set and can be cleared only by the
clear interrupt mask software instruction (CLI).
N — Negative Flag
The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation
produces a negative result, setting bit 7 of the result.
1 = Negative result
0 = Non-negative result
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
50
Freescale Semiconductor
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU)
Z — Zero Flag
The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation
produces a result of $00.
1 = Zero result
0 = Non-zero result
C — Carry/Borrow Flag
The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation produces a carry out of bit 7 of the
accumulator or when a subtraction operation requires a borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test
and branch, shift, and rotate — also clear or set the carry/borrow flag.
1 = Carry out of bit 7
0 = No carry out of bit 7
5.4 Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU)
The ALU performs the arithmetic and logic operations defined by the instruction set.
Refer to the CPU08 Reference Manual (document order number CPU08RM/AD) for a description of the
instructions and addressing modes and more detail about the architecture of the CPU.
5.5 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
5.5.1 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction:
• Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling interrupts. After exit from
wait mode by interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set.
• Disables the CPU clock
5.5.2 Stop Mode
The STOP instruction:
• Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling external interrupts. After
exit from stop mode by external interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set.
• Disables the CPU clock
After exiting stop mode, the CPU clock begins running after the oscillator stabilization delay.
5.6 CPU During Break Interrupts
If a break module is present on the MCU, the CPU starts a break interrupt by:
• Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction
• Loading the program counter with $FFFC:$FFFD or with $FEFC:$FEFD in monitor mode
The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in progress. If the break address
register match occurs on the last cycle of a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately.
A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the break interrupt and returns the MCU
to normal operation if the break interrupt has been deasserted.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
51
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
5.7 Instruction Set Summary
Table 5-1 provides a summary of the M68HC08 instruction set.
ADC #opr
ADC opr
ADC opr
ADC opr,X
ADC opr,X
ADC ,X
ADC opr,SP
ADC opr,SP
ADD #opr
ADD opr
ADD opr
ADD opr,X
ADD opr,X
ADD ,X
ADD opr,SP
ADD opr,SP
V H I N Z C
A ← (A) + (M) + (C)
Add with Carry
A ← (A) + (M)
Add without Carry
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
– IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A9
B9
C9
D9
E9
F9
9EE9
9ED9
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
IMM
DIR
EXT
– IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
AB
BB
CB
DB
EB
FB
9EEB
9EDB
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
Cycles
Effect
on CCR
Description
Operand
Operation
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 5-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 1 of 6)
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
AIS #opr
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to SP
SP ← (SP) + (16 « M)
– – – – – – IMM
A7
ii
2
AIX #opr
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to H:X
H:X ← (H:X) + (16 « M)
– – – – – – IMM
AF
ii
2
A ← (A) & (M)
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
0 – – – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A4
B4
C4
D4
E4
F4
9EE4
9ED4
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
0
DIR
INH
INH
– – IX1
IX
SP1
38 dd
48
58
68 ff
78
9E68 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
C
DIR
INH
– – INH
IX1
IX
SP1
37 dd
47
57
67 ff
77
9E67 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
AND #opr
AND opr
AND opr
AND opr,X
AND opr,X
AND ,X
AND opr,SP
AND opr,SP
ASL opr
ASLA
ASLX
ASL opr,X
ASL ,X
ASL opr,SP
Logical AND
Arithmetic Shift Left
(Same as LSL)
C
b7
ASR opr
ASRA
ASRX
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,SP
Arithmetic Shift Right
BCC rel
Branch if Carry Bit Clear
b0
b7
b0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
Mn ← 0
ff
ee ff
– – – – – – REL
24
rr
3
DIR (b0)
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
– – – – – – DIR (b3)
DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
11
13
15
17
19
1B
1D
1F
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
BCLR n, opr
Clear Bit n in M
BCS rel
Branch if Carry Bit Set (Same as BLO)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
– – – – – – REL
25
rr
3
BEQ rel
Branch if Equal
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 1
– – – – – – REL
27
rr
3
BGE opr
Branch if Greater Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) = 0
– – – – – – REL
90
rr
3
BGT opr
Branch if Greater Than (Signed
Operands)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 0 – – – – – – REL
92
rr
3
BHCC rel
Branch if Half Carry Bit Clear
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 0
– – – – – – REL
28
rr
BHCS rel
Branch if Half Carry Bit Set
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 1
– – – – – – REL
29
rr
BHI rel
Branch if Higher
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 0
– – – – – – REL
22
rr
3
3
3
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
52
Freescale Semiconductor
Instruction Set Summary
Effect
on CCR
V H I N Z C
BHS rel
Branch if Higher or Same
(Same as BCC)
BIH rel
BIL rel
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
– – – – – – REL
Branch if IRQ Pin High
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 1
Branch if IRQ Pin Low
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 0
(A) & (M)
BIT #opr
BIT opr
BIT opr
BIT opr,X
BIT opr,X
BIT ,X
BIT opr,SP
BIT opr,SP
Bit Test
BLE opr
Branch if Less Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 5-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 2 of 6)
24
rr
3
– – – – – – REL
2F
rr
3
– – – – – – REL
2E
rr
3
IMM
DIR
EXT
0 – – – IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A5
B5
C5
D5
E5
F5
9EE5
9ED5
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
rr
3
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 1 – – – – – – REL
93
BLO rel
Branch if Lower (Same as BCS)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
– – – – – – REL
25
rr
3
BLS rel
Branch if Lower or Same
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 1
– – – – – – REL
23
rr
3
BLT opr
Branch if Less Than (Signed Operands)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) =1
– – – – – – REL
91
rr
3
BMC rel
Branch if Interrupt Mask Clear
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 0
– – – – – – REL
2C
rr
3
BMI rel
Branch if Minus
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 1
– – – – – – REL
2B
rr
3
BMS rel
Branch if Interrupt Mask Set
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 1
– – – – – – REL
2D
rr
3
3
BNE rel
Branch if Not Equal
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 0
– – – – – – REL
26
rr
BPL rel
Branch if Plus
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 0
– – – – – – REL
2A
rr
3
BRA rel
Branch Always
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel
– – – – – – REL
20
rr
3
DIR (b0)
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
DIR (b3)
– – – – – DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
01
03
05
07
09
0B
0D
0F
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
– – – – – – REL
21
rr
3
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 1
DIR (b0)
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
DIR (b3)
– – – – – DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
00
02
04
06
08
0A
0C
0E
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
Mn ← 1
DIR (b0)
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
– – – – – – DIR (b3)
DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
10
12
14
16
18
1A
1C
1E
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
PC ← (PC) + 2; push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1
PC ← (PC) + rel
– – – – – – REL
AD
rr
4
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (X) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
DIR
IMM
– – – – – – IMM
IX1+
IX+
SP1
31
41
51
61
71
9E61
dd rr
ii rr
ii rr
ff rr
rr
ff rr
5
4
4
5
4
6
BRCLR n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Clear
BRN rel
Branch Never
BRSET n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Set
BSET n,opr
Set Bit n in M
BSR rel
Branch to Subroutine
CBEQ opr,rel
CBEQA #opr,rel
CBEQX #opr,rel Compare and Branch if Equal
CBEQ opr,X+,rel
CBEQ X+,rel
CBEQ opr,SP,rel
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2
CLC
Clear Carry Bit
C←0
– – – – – 0 INH
98
1
CLI
Clear Interrupt Mask
I←0
– – 0 – – – INH
9A
2
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
53
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CLR opr
CLRA
CLRX
CLRH
CLR opr,X
CLR ,X
CLR opr,SP
CMP #opr
CMP opr
CMP opr
CMP opr,X
CMP opr,X
CMP ,X
CMP opr,SP
CMP opr,SP
V H I N Z C
Clear
Compare A with M
COM opr
COMA
COMX
COM opr,X
COM ,X
COM opr,SP
Complement (One’s Complement)
CPHX #opr
CPHX opr
Compare H:X with M
CPX #opr
CPX opr
CPX opr
CPX ,X
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,SP
CPX opr,SP
Compare X with M
DAA
Decimal Adjust A
DEC opr
DECA
DECX
DEC opr,X
DEC ,X
DEC opr,SP
Decrement
DIV
Divide
INC opr
INCA
INCX
INC opr,X
INC ,X
INC opr,SP
Exclusive OR M with A
Increment
M ← $00
A ← $00
X ← $00
H ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
DIR
INH
INH
0 – – 0 1 – INH
IX1
IX
SP1
3F dd
4F
5F
8C
6F ff
7F
9E6F ff
(A) – (M)
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
– – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A1
B1
C1
D1
E1
F1
9EE1
9ED1
DIR
INH
INH
0 – – 1
IX1
IX
SP1
33 dd
43
53
63 ff
73
9E63 ff
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
A ← (A) = $FF – (M)
X ← (X) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
(H:X) – (M:M + 1)
(X) – (M)
(A)10
DBNZ opr,rel
DBNZA rel
DBNZX rel
Decrement and Branch if Not Zero
DBNZ opr,X,rel
DBNZ X,rel
DBNZ opr,SP,rel
EOR #opr
EOR opr
EOR opr
EOR opr,X
EOR opr,X
EOR ,X
EOR opr,SP
EOR opr,SP
Effect
on CCR
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
4
1
1
4
3
5
ii ii+1
dd
3
4
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
– – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A3
B3
C3
D3
E3
F3
9EE3
9ED3
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
U – – INH
72
A ← (A) – 1 or M ← (M) – 1 or X ← (X) – 1
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
DIR
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
INH
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
– – – – – – INH
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
IX1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
IX
PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
SP1
3B
4B
5B
6B
7B
9E6B
ff
ee ff
2
dd rr
rr
rr
ff rr
rr
ff rr
M ← (M) – 1
A ← (A) – 1
X ← (X) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
DIR
INH
INH
– – –
IX1
IX
SP1
A ← (H:A)/(X)
H ← Remainder
– – – – INH
52
A ← (A ⊕ M)
IMM
DIR
EXT
0 – – – IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A8
B8
C8
D8
E8
F8
9EE8
9ED8
DIR
INH
– – – INH
IX1
IX
SP1
3C dd
4C
5C
6C ff
7C
9E6C ff
M ← (M) + 1
A ← (A) + 1
X ← (X) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
3
1
1
1
3
2
4
65
75
– – IMM
DIR
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 5-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 3 of 6)
3A dd
4A
5A
6A ff
7A
9E6A ff
5
3
3
5
4
6
4
1
1
4
3
5
7
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
4
1
1
4
3
5
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
54
Freescale Semiconductor
Instruction Set Summary
JSR opr
JSR opr
JSR opr,X
JSR opr,X
JSR ,X
Jump to Subroutine
LDHX #opr
LDHX opr
Load H:X from M
2
3
4
3
2
PC ← (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3)
Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – 1
PC ← Unconditional Address
DIR
EXT
– – – – – – IX2
IX1
IX
BD
CD
DD
ED
FD
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
4
5
6
5
4
A ← (M)
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
0 – – – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A6
B6
C6
D6
E6
F6
9EE6
9ED6
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
ii jj
dd
3
4
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
H:X ← (M:M + 1)
Logical Shift Left
(Same as ASL)
Logical Shift Right
MOV opr,opr
MOV opr,X+
MOV #opr,opr
MOV X+,opr
Move
MUL
Unsigned multiply
C
b7
45
55
AE
BE
CE
DE
EE
FE
9EEE
9EDE
0
DIR
INH
INH
– – IX1
IX
SP1
38 dd
48
58
68 ff
78
9E68 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
C
DIR
INH
– – 0 INH
IX1
IX
SP1
34 dd
44
54
64 ff
74
9E64 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
b0
0
IMM
DIR
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
0 – – – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
X ← (M)
b7
Negate (Two’s Complement)
0 – – –
b0
H:X ← (H:X) + 1 (IX+D, DIX+)
DD
DIX+
0 – – – IMD
IX+D
X:A ← (X) × (A)
– 0 – – – 0 INH
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
A ← –(A) = $00 – (A)
X ← –(X) = $00 – (X)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
DIR
INH
INH
– – IX1
IX
SP1
(M)Destination ← (M)Source
4E
5E
6E
7E
dd dd
dd
ii dd
dd
42
No Operation
None
– – – – – – INH
9D
NSA
Nibble Swap A
A ← (A[3:0]:A[7:4])
– – – – – – INH
62
A ← (A) | (M)
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
0 – – –
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
AA
BA
CA
DA
EA
FA
9EEA
9EDA
Inclusive OR A and M
ff
ee ff
5
4
4
4
5
30 dd
40
50
60 ff
70
9E60 ff
NOP
ORA #opr
ORA opr
ORA opr
ORA opr,X
ORA opr,X
ORA ,X
ORA opr,SP
ORA opr,SP
Cycles
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Load X from M
LSR opr
LSRA
LSRX
LSR opr,X
LSR ,X
LSR opr,SP
NEG opr
NEGA
NEGX
NEG opr,X
NEG ,X
NEG opr,SP
BC
CC
DC
EC
FC
Jump
Load A from M
LSL opr
LSLA
LSLX
LSL opr,X
LSL ,X
LSL opr,SP
PC ← Jump Address
DIR
EXT
– – – – – – IX2
IX1
IX
Effect
on CCR
Description
V H I N Z C
LDA #opr
LDA opr
LDA opr
LDA opr,X
LDA opr,X
LDA ,X
LDA opr,SP
LDA opr,SP
LDX #opr
LDX opr
LDX opr
LDX opr,X
LDX opr,X
LDX ,X
LDX opr,SP
LDX opr,SP
Operand
JMP opr
JMP opr
JMP opr,X
JMP opr,X
JMP ,X
Operation
Address
Mode
Source
Form
Opcode
Table 5-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 4 of 6)
4
1
1
4
3
5
1
3
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
PSHA
Push A onto Stack
Push (A); SP ← (SP) – 1
– – – – – – INH
87
2
PSHH
Push H onto Stack
Push (H); SP ← (SP) – 1
– – – – – – INH
8B
2
PSHX
Push X onto Stack
Push (X); SP ← (SP) – 1
– – – – – – INH
89
2
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
55
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
V H I N Z C
Cycles
Effect
on CCR
Description
Operand
Operation
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 5-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 5 of 6)
PULA
Pull A from Stack
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (A)
– – – – – – INH
86
2
PULH
Pull H from Stack
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (H)
– – – – – – INH
8A
2
PULX
Pull X from Stack
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (X)
– – – – – – INH
C
DIR
INH
INH
– – IX1
IX
SP1
39 dd
49
59
69 ff
79
9E69 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
DIR
INH
– – INH
IX1
IX
SP1
36 dd
46
56
66 ff
76
9E66 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
ROL opr
ROLA
ROLX
ROL opr,X
ROL ,X
ROL opr,SP
Rotate Left through Carry
b7
b0
88
2
ROR opr
RORA
RORX
ROR opr,X
ROR ,X
ROR opr,SP
Rotate Right through Carry
RSP
Reset Stack Pointer
SP ← $FF
– – – – – – INH
9C
1
RTI
Return from Interrupt
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (CCR)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (A)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (X)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCL)
INH
80
7
RTS
Return from Subroutine
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCL)
– – – – – – INH
81
4
A ← (A) – (M) – (C)
IMM
DIR
EXT
– – IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A2
B2
C2
D2
E2
F2
9EE2
9ED2
SBC #opr
SBC opr
SBC opr
SBC opr,X
SBC opr,X
SBC ,X
SBC opr,SP
SBC opr,SP
C
b7
Subtract with Carry
b0
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
SEC
Set Carry Bit
C←1
– – – – – 1 INH
99
1
SEI
Set Interrupt Mask
I←1
– – 1 – – – INH
9B
2
M ← (A)
DIR
EXT
IX2
0 – – – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
B7
C7
D7
E7
F7
9EE7
9ED7
(M:M + 1) ← (H:X)
0 – – – DIR
35
I ← 0; Stop Processing
– – 0 – – – INH
8E
M ← (X)
DIR
EXT
IX2
0 – – – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
BF
CF
DF
EF
FF
9EEF
9EDF
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
IMM
DIR
EXT
– – IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A0
B0
C0
D0
E0
F0
9EE0
9ED0
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
STA opr
STA opr
STA opr,X
STA opr,X
STA ,X
STA opr,SP
STA opr,SP
Store A in M
STHX opr
Store H:X in M
STOP
Enable Interrupts, Stop Processing,
Refer to MCU Documentation
STX opr
STX opr
STX opr,X
STX opr,X
STX ,X
STX opr,SP
STX opr,SP
SUB #opr
SUB opr
SUB opr
SUB opr,X
SUB opr,X
SUB ,X
SUB opr,SP
SUB opr,SP
Store X in M
Subtract
A ← (A) – (M)
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
4
1
ff
ee ff
ff
ee ff
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
56
Freescale Semiconductor
Opcode Map
SWI
Software Interrupt
PC ← (PC) + 1; Push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (X)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (A)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (CCR)
SP ← (SP) – 1; I ← 1
PCH ← Interrupt Vector High Byte
PCL ← Interrupt Vector Low Byte
– – 1 – – – INH
83
9
CCR ← (A)
INH
84
2
X ← (A)
– – – – – – INH
97
1
A ← (CCR)
– – – – – – INH
85
(A) – $00 or (X) – $00 or (M) – $00
DIR
INH
INH
0 – – –
IX1
IX
SP1
H:X ← (SP) + 1
– – – – – – INH
95
2
A ← (X)
– – – – – – INH
9F
1
(SP) ← (H:X) – 1
– – – – – – INH
94
2
I bit ← 0; Inhibit CPU clocking
until interrupted
– – 0 – – – INH
8F
1
TAP
Transfer A to CCR
Transfer A to X
TPA
Transfer CCR to A
Test for Negative or Zero
TSX
Transfer SP to H:X
TXA
Transfer X to A
TXS
Transfer H:X to SP
WAIT
A
C
CCR
dd
dd rr
DD
DIR
DIX+
ee ff
EXT
ff
H
H
hh ll
I
ii
IMD
IMM
INH
IX
IX+
IX+D
IX1
IX1+
IX2
M
N
Cycles
V H I N Z C
TAX
TST opr
TSTA
TSTX
TST opr,X
TST ,X
TST opr,SP
Effect
on CCR
Description
Operand
Operation
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 5-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 6 of 6)
Enable Interrupts; Wait for Interrupt
Accumulator
Carry/borrow bit
Condition code register
Direct address of operand
Direct address of operand and relative offset of branch instruction
Direct to direct addressing mode
Direct addressing mode
Direct to indexed with post increment addressing mode
High and low bytes of offset in indexed, 16-bit offset addressing
Extended addressing mode
Offset byte in indexed, 8-bit offset addressing
Half-carry bit
Index register high byte
High and low bytes of operand address in extended addressing
Interrupt mask
Immediate operand byte
Immediate source to direct destination addressing mode
Immediate addressing mode
Inherent addressing mode
Indexed, no offset addressing mode
Indexed, no offset, post increment addressing mode
Indexed with post increment to direct addressing mode
Indexed, 8-bit offset addressing mode
Indexed, 8-bit offset, post increment addressing mode
Indexed, 16-bit offset addressing mode
Memory location
Negative bit
n
opr
PC
PCH
PCL
REL
rel
rr
SP1
SP2
SP
U
V
X
Z
&
|
⊕
()
–( )
#
«
←
?
:
—
3D dd
4D
5D
6D ff
7D
9E6D ff
1
3
1
1
3
2
4
Any bit
Operand (one or two bytes)
Program counter
Program counter high byte
Program counter low byte
Relative addressing mode
Relative program counter offset byte
Relative program counter offset byte
Stack pointer, 8-bit offset addressing mode
Stack pointer 16-bit offset addressing mode
Stack pointer
Undefined
Overflow bit
Index register low byte
Zero bit
Logical AND
Logical OR
Logical EXCLUSIVE OR
Contents of
Negation (two’s complement)
Immediate value
Sign extend
Loaded with
If
Concatenated with
Set or cleared
Not affected
5.8 Opcode Map
See Table 5-2.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
57
MSB
Branch
REL
DIR
INH
3
4
0
1
2
5
BRSET0
3 DIR
5
BRCLR0
3 DIR
5
BRSET1
3 DIR
5
BRCLR1
3 DIR
5
BRSET2
3 DIR
5
BRCLR2
3 DIR
5
BRSET3
3 DIR
5
BRCLR3
3 DIR
5
BRSET4
3 DIR
5
BRCLR4
3 DIR
5
BRSET5
3 DIR
5
BRCLR5
3 DIR
5
BRSET6
3 DIR
5
BRCLR6
3 DIR
5
BRSET7
3 DIR
5
BRCLR7
3 DIR
4
BSET0
2 DIR
4
BCLR0
2 DIR
4
BSET1
2 DIR
4
BCLR1
2 DIR
4
BSET2
2 DIR
4
BCLR2
2 DIR
4
BSET3
2 DIR
4
BCLR3
2 DIR
4
BSET4
2 DIR
4
BCLR4
2 DIR
4
BSET5
2 DIR
4
BCLR5
2 DIR
4
BSET6
2 DIR
4
BCLR6
2 DIR
4
BSET7
2 DIR
4
BCLR7
2 DIR
3
BRA
2 REL
3
BRN
2 REL
3
BHI
2 REL
3
BLS
2 REL
3
BCC
2 REL
3
BCS
2 REL
3
BNE
2 REL
3
BEQ
2 REL
3
BHCC
2 REL
3
BHCS
2 REL
3
BPL
2 REL
3
BMI
2 REL
3
BMC
2 REL
3
BMS
2 REL
3
BIL
2 REL
3
BIH
2 REL
Read-Modify-Write
INH
IX1
5
6
1
NEGX
1 INH
4
CBEQX
3 IMM
7
DIV
1 INH
1
COMX
1 INH
1
LSRX
1 INH
4
LDHX
2 DIR
1
RORX
1 INH
1
ASRX
1 INH
1
LSLX
1 INH
1
ROLX
1 INH
1
DECX
1 INH
3
DBNZX
2 INH
1
INCX
1 INH
1
TSTX
1 INH
4
MOV
2 DIX+
1
CLRX
1 INH
4
NEG
2
IX1
5
CBEQ
3 IX1+
3
NSA
1 INH
4
COM
2 IX1
4
LSR
2 IX1
3
CPHX
3 IMM
4
ROR
2 IX1
4
ASR
2 IX1
4
LSL
2 IX1
4
ROL
2 IX1
4
DEC
2 IX1
5
DBNZ
3 IX1
4
INC
2 IX1
3
TST
2 IX1
4
MOV
3 IMD
3
CLR
2 IX1
SP1
IX
9E6
7
Control
INH
INH
8
9
Register/Memory
IX2
SP2
IMM
DIR
EXT
A
B
C
D
9ED
4
SUB
3 EXT
4
CMP
3 EXT
4
SBC
3 EXT
4
CPX
3 EXT
4
AND
3 EXT
4
BIT
3 EXT
4
LDA
3 EXT
4
STA
3 EXT
4
EOR
3 EXT
4
ADC
3 EXT
4
ORA
3 EXT
4
ADD
3 EXT
3
JMP
3 EXT
5
JSR
3 EXT
4
LDX
3 EXT
4
STX
3 EXT
4
SUB
3 IX2
4
CMP
3 IX2
4
SBC
3 IX2
4
CPX
3 IX2
4
AND
3 IX2
4
BIT
3 IX2
4
LDA
3 IX2
4
STA
3 IX2
4
EOR
3 IX2
4
ADC
3 IX2
4
ORA
3 IX2
4
ADD
3 IX2
4
JMP
3 IX2
6
JSR
3 IX2
4
LDX
3 IX2
4
STX
3 IX2
5
SUB
4 SP2
5
CMP
4 SP2
5
SBC
4 SP2
5
CPX
4 SP2
5
AND
4 SP2
5
BIT
4 SP2
5
LDA
4 SP2
5
STA
4 SP2
5
EOR
4 SP2
5
ADC
4 SP2
5
ORA
4 SP2
5
ADD
4 SP2
IX1
SP1
IX
E
9EE
F
LSB
0
1
2
3
4
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
Freescale Semiconductor
F
4
1
NEG
NEGA
2 DIR 1 INH
5
4
CBEQ CBEQA
3 DIR 3 IMM
5
MUL
1 INH
4
1
COM
COMA
2 DIR 1 INH
4
1
LSR
LSRA
2 DIR 1 INH
4
3
STHX
LDHX
2 DIR 3 IMM
4
1
ROR
RORA
2 DIR 1 INH
4
1
ASR
ASRA
2 DIR 1 INH
4
1
LSL
LSLA
2 DIR 1 INH
4
1
ROL
ROLA
2 DIR 1 INH
4
1
DEC
DECA
2 DIR 1 INH
5
3
DBNZ DBNZA
3 DIR 2 INH
4
1
INC
INCA
2 DIR 1 INH
3
1
TST
TSTA
2 DIR 1 INH
5
MOV
3 DD
3
1
CLR
CLRA
2 DIR 1 INH
INH Inherent
REL Relative
IMM Immediate
IX
Indexed, No Offset
DIR Direct
IX1 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset
EXT Extended
IX2 Indexed, 16-Bit Offset
DD Direct-Direct
IMD Immediate-Direct
IX+D Indexed-Direct DIX+ Direct-Indexed
*Pre-byte for stack pointer indexed instructions
5
3
NEG
NEG
3 SP1 1 IX
6
4
CBEQ
CBEQ
4 SP1 2 IX+
2
DAA
1 INH
5
3
COM
COM
3 SP1 1 IX
5
3
LSR
LSR
3 SP1 1 IX
4
CPHX
2 DIR
5
3
ROR
ROR
3 SP1 1 IX
5
3
ASR
ASR
3 SP1 1 IX
5
3
LSL
LSL
3 SP1 1 IX
5
3
ROL
ROL
3 SP1 1 IX
5
3
DEC
DEC
3 SP1 1 IX
6
4
DBNZ
DBNZ
4 SP1 2 IX
5
3
INC
INC
3 SP1 1 IX
4
2
TST
TST
3 SP1 1 IX
4
MOV
2 IX+D
4
2
CLR
CLR
3 SP1 1 IX
SP1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset
SP2 Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset
IX+ Indexed, No Offset with
Post Increment
IX1+ Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with
Post Increment
7
3
RTI
BGE
1 INH 2 REL
4
3
RTS
BLT
1 INH 2 REL
3
BGT
2 REL
9
3
SWI
BLE
1 INH 2 REL
2
2
TAP
TXS
1 INH 1 INH
1
2
TPA
TSX
1 INH 1 INH
2
PULA
1 INH
2
1
PSHA
TAX
1 INH 1 INH
2
1
PULX
CLC
1 INH 1 INH
2
1
PSHX
SEC
1 INH 1 INH
2
2
PULH
CLI
1 INH 1 INH
2
2
PSHH
SEI
1 INH 1 INH
1
1
CLRH
RSP
1 INH 1 INH
1
NOP
1 INH
1
STOP
*
1 INH
1
1
WAIT
TXA
1 INH 1 INH
2
SUB
2 IMM
2
CMP
2 IMM
2
SBC
2 IMM
2
CPX
2 IMM
2
AND
2 IMM
2
BIT
2 IMM
2
LDA
2 IMM
2
AIS
2 IMM
2
EOR
2 IMM
2
ADC
2 IMM
2
ORA
2 IMM
2
ADD
2 IMM
3
SUB
2 DIR
3
CMP
2 DIR
3
SBC
2 DIR
3
CPX
2 DIR
3
AND
2 DIR
3
BIT
2 DIR
3
LDA
2 DIR
3
STA
2 DIR
3
EOR
2 DIR
3
ADC
2 DIR
3
ORA
2 DIR
3
ADD
2 DIR
2
JMP
2 DIR
4
4
BSR
JSR
2 REL 2 DIR
2
3
LDX
LDX
2 IMM 2 DIR
2
3
AIX
STX
2 IMM 2 DIR
MSB
0
3
SUB
2 IX1
3
CMP
2 IX1
3
SBC
2 IX1
3
CPX
2 IX1
3
AND
2 IX1
3
BIT
2 IX1
3
LDA
2 IX1
3
STA
2 IX1
3
EOR
2 IX1
3
ADC
2 IX1
3
ORA
2 IX1
3
ADD
2 IX1
3
JMP
2 IX1
5
JSR
2 IX1
5
3
LDX
LDX
4 SP2 2 IX1
5
3
STX
STX
4 SP2 2 IX1
4
SUB
3 SP1
4
CMP
3 SP1
4
SBC
3 SP1
4
CPX
3 SP1
4
AND
3 SP1
4
BIT
3 SP1
4
LDA
3 SP1
4
STA
3 SP1
4
EOR
3 SP1
4
ADC
3 SP1
4
ORA
3 SP1
4
ADD
3 SP1
2
SUB
1 IX
2
CMP
1 IX
2
SBC
1 IX
2
CPX
1 IX
2
AND
1 IX
2
BIT
1 IX
2
LDA
1 IX
2
STA
1 IX
2
EOR
1 IX
2
ADC
1 IX
2
ORA
1 IX
2
ADD
1 IX
2
JMP
1 IX
4
JSR
1 IX
4
2
LDX
LDX
3 SP1 1 IX
4
2
STX
STX
3 SP1 1 IX
High Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
LSB
Low Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
0
5
Cycles
BRSET0 Opcode Mnemonic
3 DIR Number of Bytes / Addressing Mode
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
58
Table 5-2. Opcode Map
Bit Manipulation
DIR
DIR
Chapter 6
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
6.1 Introduction
The internal clock generator module (ICG) is used to create a stable clock source for the microcontroller
without using any external components. The ICG generates the oscillator output clock (CGMXCLK),
which is used by the COP, LVI, and other modules. The ICG also generates the clock generator output
(CGMOUT), which is fed to the system integration module (SIM) to create the bus clocks. The bus
frequency will be one-fourth the frequency of CGMXCLK and one-half the frequency of CGMOUT.
6.2 Features
The ICG has these features:
• External clock generator, either 1-pin external source or 2-pin crystal
• Internal clock generator with programmable frequency output in integer multiples of a nominal
frequency (307.2 kHz ±25 percent)
• Frequency adjust (trim) register to improve variability to ±2 percent
• Bus clock software selectable from either internal or external clock
• Clock monitor for both internal and external clocks
6.3 Functional Description
The ICG, shown in Figure 6-1, contains these major submodules:
• Clock enable circuit
• Internal clock generator
• External clock generator
• Clock monitor circuit
• Clock selection circuit
6.3.1 Clock Enable Circuit
The clock enable circuit is used to enable the internal clock (ICLK) or external clock (ECLK). The clock
enable circuit generates an ICG stop (ICGSTOP) signal which stops all clocks (ICLK, ECLK, and the
low-frequency base clock, IBASE) low. ICGSTOP is set and the ICG is disabled in stop mode.
The internal clock enable signal (ICGEN) turns on the internal clock generator which generates ICLK.
ICGEN is set (active) whenever the ICGON bit is set and the ICGSTOP signal is clear. When ICGEN is
clear, ICLK and IBASE are both low.
The external clock enable signal (ECGEN) turns on the external clock generator which generates ECLK.
ECGEN is set (active) whenever the ECGON bit is set and the ICGSTOP signal is clear. When ECGEN
is clear, ECLK is low.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
59
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
CS
CGMOUT
RESET
CGMXCLK
CLOCK SELECTION
CIRCUIT
IOFF
EOFF
CMON
CPU_INT
CMF
ECGS
CLOCK
MONITOR/SWITCHER
CIRCUIT
ICGS
DDIV
INTERNAL CLOCK
GENERATOR
N[6:0]
DSTG
TRIM[7:0]
ICLK
IBASE
ICGEN
SIMOSCEN
CLOCK ENABLE CIRCUIT
ECGON
ICGON
ECGEN
EXTERNAL CLOCK
GENERATOR
EXTSLOW
INTERNAL
TO MCU
OSC1
ECLK
OSC2
EXTERNAL
NAME
CONFIGURATION REGISTER BIT
NAME
REGISTER BIT
NAME
TOP LEVEL SIGNAL
NAME
MODULE SIGNAL
Figure 6-1. ICG Module Block Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
60
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
6.3.2 Internal Clock Generator
The internal clock generator, shown in Figure 6-2, creates a low-frequency base clock (IBASE), which
operates at a nominal frequency (fNOM) of 307.2 kHz ±25 percent, and an internal clock (ICLK) which is
an integer multiple of IBASE. This multiple is the ICG multiplier factor (N), which is programmed in the
ICG multiplier register (ICGMR). The internal clock generator is turned off and the output clocks (IBASE
and ICLK) are held low when the internal clock generator enable signal (ICGEN) is clear.
ICGEN
VOLTAGE &
CURRENT
REFERENCES
++
DSTG[7:0]
+
DIGITAL
LOOP
FILTER
–
DDIV[3:0]
DIGITALLY
CONTROLLED
OSCILLATOR
ICLK
––
TRIM[7:0]
FREQUENCY
COMPARATOR
CLOCK GENERATOR
N[6:0]
MODULO
N
DIVIDER
IBASE
NAME
REGISTER BIT
NAME
MODULE SIGNAL
Figure 6-2. Internal Clock Generator Block Diagram
The internal clock generator contains:
• A digitally controlled oscillator
• A modulo N divider
• A frequency comparator, which contains voltage and current references, a frequency to voltage
converter, and comparators
• A digital loop filter
6.3.2.1 Digitally Controlled Oscillator
The digitally controlled oscillator (DCO) is an inaccurate oscillator which generates the internal clock
(ICLK). The clock period of ICLK is dependent on the digital loop filter outputs (DSTG[7:0] and DDIV[3:0]).
Because there is only a limited number of bits in DDIV and DSTG, the precision of the output (ICLK) is
restricted to a long-term precision of approximately ±0.202 percent to ±0.368 percent when measured
over several cycles (of the desired frequency). Additionally, since the propagation delays of the devices
used in the DCO ring oscillator are a measurable fraction of the bus clock period, reaching the long-term
precision may require alternately running faster and slower than desired, making the worst case
cycle-to-cycle frequency variation ±6.45 percent to ±11.8 percent (of the desired frequency). The valid
values of DDIV:DSTG range from $000 to $9FF. For more information on the quantization error in the
DCO, see 6.4.4 Quantization Error in DCO Output.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
61
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
6.3.2.2 Modulo N Divider
The modulo N divider creates the low-frequency base clock (IBASE) by dividing the internal clock (ICLK)
by the ICG multiplier factor (N) contained in the ICG multiplier register (ICGMR). When N is programmed
to a $01 or $00, the divider is disabled and ICLK is passed through to IBASE undivided. When the internal
clock generator is stable, the frequency of IBASE will be equal to the nominal frequency (fNOM) of
307.2 kHz ±25 percent.
6.3.2.3 Frequency Comparator
The frequency comparator effectively compares the low-frequency base clock (IBASE) to a nominal
frequency, fNOM. First, the frequency comparator converts IBASE to a voltage by charging a known
capacitor with a current reference for a period dependent on IBASE. This voltage is compared to a voltage
reference with comparators, whose outputs are fed to the digital loop filter. The dependence of these
outputs on the capacitor size, current reference, and voltage reference causes up to ±25 percent error in
fNOM.
6.3.2.4 Digital Loop Filter
The digital loop filter (DLF) uses the outputs of the frequency comparator to adjust the internal clock
(ICLK) clock period. The DLF generates the DCO divider control bits (DDIV[3:0]) and the DCO stage
control bits (DSTG[7:0]), which are fed to the DCO. The DLF first concatenates the DDIV and DSTG
registers (DDIV[3:0]:DSTG[7:0]) and then adds or subtracts a value dependent on the relative error in the
low-frequency base clock’s period, as shown in Table 6-1. In some extreme error conditions, such as
operating at a VDD level which is out of specification, the DLF may attempt to use a value above the
maximum ($9FF) or below the minimum ($000). In both cases, the value for DDIV will be between $A and
$F. In this range, the DDIV value will be interpreted the same as $9 (the slowest condition). Recovering
from this condition requires subtracting (increasing frequency) in the normal fashion until the value is
again below $9FF (if the desired value is $9xx, the value may settle at $Axx through $Fxx, an acceptable
operating condition). If the error is less than ±5 percent, the internal clock generator’s filter stable indicator
(FICGS) is set, indicating relative frequency accuracy to the clock monitor.
Table 6-1. Correction Sizes from DLF to DCO
Frequency Error of IBASE
Compared to fNOM
DDVI[3:0]:DSTG[7:0]
Correction
IBASE < 0.85 fNOM
–32 (–$020)
0.85 fNOM < IBASE
IBASE < 0.95 fNOM
–8 (–$008)
0.95 fNOM < IBASE
IBASE < fNOM
–1 (–$001)
fNOM < IBASE
IBASE < 1.05 fNOM
+1 (+$001)
1.05 fNOM < IBASE
IBASE < 1.15 fNOM
+8 (+$008)
1.15 fNOM < IBASE
+32 (+$020)
Current to New
DDIV[3:0]:DSTG[7:0]
Relative Correction
in DCO
Min
$xFF to $xDF
–2/31
–6.45%
Max
$x20 to $x00
–2/19
–10.5%
Min
$xFF to $xF7
–0.5/31
–1.61%
Max
$x08 to $x00
–0.5/17.5
–2.86%
Min
$xFF to $xFE
–0.0625/31
–0.202%
Max
$x01 to $x00
–0.0625/17.0625
–0.366%
Min
$xFE to $xFF
+0.0625/30.9375
+0.202%
Max
$x00 to $x01
+0.0625/17
+0.368%
Min
$xF7 to $xFF
+0.5/30.5
+1.64%
Max
$x00 to $x08
+0.5/17
+2.94%
Min
$xDF to $xFF
+2/29
+6.90%
Max
$x00 to $x20
+2/17
+11.8%
x: Maximum error is independent of value in DDIV[3:0]. DDIV increments or decrements when an addition to DSTG[7:0]
carries or borrows.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
62
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
6.3.3 External Clock Generator
The ICG also provides for an external oscillator or clock source, if desired. The external clock generator,
shown in Figure 6-3, contains an external oscillator amplifier and an external clock input path.
STOP
ECLK
INPUT PATH
ECGON
AMPLIFIER
EXTERNAL
CLOCK
GENERATOR
EXTSLOW
INTERNAL TO MCU
OSC1
OSC2
EXTERNAL
RB
NAME
CONFIGURATION REGISTER BIT
NAME
TOP LEVEL SIGNAL
R S*
*RS can be 0 (shorted) when used
with higher-frequency crystals.
Refer to manufacturer’s data.
X1
NAME
REGISTER BIT
NAME
MODULE SIGNAL
C1
C2
COMPONENTS REQUIRED FOR
EXTERNAL CRYSTAL USE ONLY
Figure 6-3. External Clock Generator Block Diagram
6.3.3.1 External Oscillator Amplifier
The external oscillator amplifier provides the gain required by an external crystal connected in a Pierce
oscillator configuration. The amount of this gain is controlled by the slow external (EXTSLOW) bit in the
configuration register. When EXTSLOW is set, the amplifier gain is reduced for operating low-frequency
crystals (32 kHz to 100 kHz). When EXTSLOW is clear, the amplifier gain will be sufficient for 1-MHz to
8-MHz crystals. EXTSLOW must be configured correctly for the given crystal or the circuit may not
operate.
The amplifier is enabled when the ECGON bit is set and stop mode is not enabled. When the amplifier is
enabled, it will be connected between the OSC1 and OSC2 pins. In its typical configuration, the external
oscillator requires five external components:
1. Crystal, X1
2. Fixed capacitor, C1
3. Tuning capacitor, C2 (can also be a fixed capacitor)
4. Feedback resistor, RB
5. Series resistor, RS (included in the diagram to follow strict Pierce oscillator guidelines and may not
be required for all ranges of operation, especially with high frequency crystals). Refer to the crystal
manufacturer’s data for more information.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
63
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
6.3.3.2 External Clock Input Path
The external clock input path is the means by which the microcontroller uses an external clock source.
The input to the path is the OSC1 pin and the output is the external clock (ECLK). The path, which
contains input buffering, is enabled when the ECGON bit is set and stop mode is not enabled.
6.3.4 Clock Monitor Circuit
The ICG contains a clock monitor circuit which, when enabled, will continuously monitor both the external
clock (ECLK) and the internal clock (ICLK) to determine if either clock source has failed based on these
conditions:
• Either ICLK or ECLK has stopped.
• The frequency of IBASE < frequency EREF divided by 4
• The frequency of ECLK < frequency of IREF divided by 4
Using the clock monitor requires both clocks to be active (ECGON and ICGON are both set). To enable
the clock monitor, both clocks must also be stable (ECGS and ICGS both set). This is to prevent the use
of the clock monitor when a clock is first turned on and potentially unstable
NOTE
Although the clock monitor can be enabled only when the both clocks are
stable (ICGS or ECGS is set), the clock monitor will remain enabled if one
of the clocks goes unstable.
The clock monitor only works if the external slow (EXTSLOW) bit in the
configuration register is properly defined with respect to the external
frequency source.
The clock monitor circuit, shown in Figure 6-4, contains these blocks:
• Clock monitor reference generator
• Internal clock activity detector
• External clock activity detector
6.3.4.1 Clock Monitor Reference Generator
The clock monitor uses a reference based on one clock source to monitor the other clock source. The
clock monitor reference generator generates the external reference clock (EREF) based on the external
clock (ECLK) and the internal reference clock (IREF) based on the internal clock (ICLK). To simplify the
circuit, the low-frequency base clock (IBASE) is used in place of ICLK because it always operates at or
near 307.2 kHz. For proper operation, EREF must be at least twice as slow as IBASE and IREF must be
at least twice as slow as ECLK.
To guarantee that IREF is slower than ECLK and EREF is slower than IBASE, one of the signals is divided
down. Which signal is divided and by how much is determined by the external slow (EXTSLOW) bit in the
configuration register, according to the rules in Table 6-2. Note that each signal (IBASE and ECLK) is
always divided by four. A longer divider is used on either IBASE or ECLK based on the EXTSLOW bit.
NOTE
If EXTSLOW is not set according to the rules defined in Table 6-2, the clock
monitor could switch clock sources unexpectedly.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
64
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
CMON
IOFF
CMON
IBASE
ICGEN
FICGS
ICLK
IBASE
ICGEN
DETECTOR
IOFF
ACTIVITY
EREF
ICGS
IBASE
EREF
ICGS
ICGON
EXTXTALEN
EXTSLOW
EXTSLOW
ESTBCLK
ECGS
DIVIDER
ECGON
ECLK
IREF
STOP
ECGS
ESTBCLK
ECGS
IREF
ECGON
ECLK
ECGEN
ECLK
ECLK
ACTIVITY
DETECTOR
CMON
EOFF
EOFF
NAME
CONFIGURATION REGISTER BIT
NAME
REGISTER BIT
NAME
TOP LEVEL SIGNAL
NAME
MODULE SIGNAL
Figure 6-4. Clock Monitor Block Diagram
The long divider (divide by 4096) is also used as an external crystal stabilization divider. The divider is
reset when the external clock generator is off (ECGEN is clear). When the external clock generator is first
turned on, the external clock generator stable bit (ECGS) will be clear. This condition automatically selects
ECLK as the input to the long divider. The external stabilization clock (ESTBCLK) will be ECLK divided
by 4096. This timeout allows the crystal to stabilize. The falling edge of ESTBCLK is used to set ECGS.
(ECGS will set after a full 16 or 4096 cycles.) When ECGS is set, the divider returns to its normal function.
ESTBCLK may be generated by either IBASE or ECLK, but any clocking will reinforce only the set
condition. If ECGS is cleared because the clock monitor determined that ECLK was inactive, the divider
will revert to a stabilization divider. Since this will change the EREF and IREF divide ratios, it is important
to turn the clock monitor off (CMON = 0) after inactivity is detected to ensure valid recovery.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
65
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
Table 6-2. Clock Monitor Reference Divider Ratios
ICGON ECGON ECGS EXTSLOW
External
Frequency
EREF
ESTBCLK
IREF
EREF
ESTBCLK
Divider
Divider
Divider
Frequency
Frequency
Ratio
Ratio
Ratio
IREF
Frequency
0
x
x
x
U
U
U
U
U
Off
0
x
0
0
x
0
Off
0
Off
0
U
U
x
x
0
x
Off
0
4096
(ECLK)
1.875 kHz
1*4
76.8 kHz ±25%
x
x
1
0
4096
(ECLK)
244 Hz
1.953 kHz
1*4
76.8 kHz ±25%
x
x
1
1
4096
(IBASE)
75 Hz
±25%
16*4
4.8 kHz
±25%
Min 30 kHz
Max 8 MHz
Min 1 MHz
Max 8 MHz
Min 30 kHz
Max 100 kHz
128*4
1*4
1.953 kHz
15.63 kHz
7.5 kHz
25.0 kHz
500 kHz
U: Unaffected. Refer to section of table where ICGON or ECGON is set to x (don’t care).
IBASE is always used as the internal frequency (307.2 kHz).
6.3.4.2 Internal Clock Activity Detector
The internal clock activity detector looks for at least one falling edge on the low-frequency base clock
(IBASE) every time the external reference (EREF) is low. Since EREF is less than half the frequency of
IBASE, this should occur every time. If it does not occur two consecutive times, the internal clock inactivity
indicator (IOFF) is set. IOFF will be cleared the next time there is a falling edge of IBASE while EREF is
low.
The internal clock stable bit (ICGS) is set when IBASE is within approximately 5 percent of the target
307.2 kHz ±25 percent for two consecutive measurements. ICGS is cleared when IBASE is outside the
5 percent of the target 307.2 kHz ±25 percent, the internal clock generator is disabled (ICGEN is clear),
or when IOFF is set.
6.3.4.3 External Clock Activity Detector
The external clock activity detector looks for at least one falling edge on the external clock (ECLK) every
time the internal reference (IREF) is low. Since IREF is less than half the frequency of ECLK, this should
occur every time. If it does not occur two consecutive times, the external clock inactivity indicator (EOFF)
is set. EOFF will be cleared the next time there is a falling edge of ECLK while IREF is low.
The external clock stable bit (ECGS) is also generated in the external clock activity detector. ECGS is set
on a falling edge of the external stabilization clock (ESTBCLK). This will be 4096 ECLK cycles after the
external clock generator on bit (ECGON) is set. ECGS is cleared when the external clock generator is
disabled (ECGON is clear) or when EOFF is set.
6.3.5 Clock Selection Circuit
The clock selection circuit, shown in Figure 6-5, contains two clock switches which generate the oscillator
output clock (CGMXCLK) from either the internal clock (ICLK) or the external clock (ECLK). The clock
selection circuit also contains a divide-by-two circuit which creates the clock generator output clock
(CGMOUT), which generates the bus clocks.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
66
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
6.3.5.1 Clock Selection Switch
The clock select switch creates the oscillator output clock (CGMXCLK) from either the internal clock
(ICLK) or the external clock (ECLK), based on the clock select bit (CS; set selects ECLK, clear selects
ICLK). When switching the CS bit, both ICLK and ECLK must be on (ICGON and ECGON set). The clock
being switched to must also be stable (ICGS or ECGS set).
SELECT
CS
ICLK
ICLK
ECLK
ECLK
IOFF
IOFF
EOFF
EOFF
OUTPUT
SYNCHRONIZING
CGMXCLK
DIV2
CLOCK
SWITCHER
CGMOUT
FORCE_I
RESET
VSS
FORCE_E
TOP LEVEL SIGNAL
NAME
NAME
REGISTER BIT
NAME
MODULE SIGNAL
Figure 6-5. Clock Selection Circuit Block Diagram
6.3.5.2 Clock Switching Circuit
To robustly switch between the internal clock (ICLK) and the external clock (ECLK), the switch assumes
the clocks are completely asynchronous, so a synchronizing circuit is required to make the transition (see
Figure 6-6). When the clock select bit is changed, the switch will continue to operate off the original clock
for between 1 and 2 cycles as the select input transitions through one side of the synchronizer. Next, the
output will be held low for between 1 and 2 cycles of the new clock as the select input transitions through
the other side. Then the output starts switching at the new clock’s frequency. This transition guarantees
that no glitches will be seen on the output even though the select input may change asynchronously to
the clocks. The unpredictably of the transition period is a necessary result of the asynchronicity.
IOFF
D
Q
D
DFF
CK
Q
DFF
QB
CK
QB
ICLK
FORCE_I
OUTPUT
ECLK
CK
FORCE_E
QB
CK
DFF
SELECT
D
QB
DFF
Q
D
Q
EOFF
FORCE_I = Force internal; reset condition
FORCE_E = Force external
Figure 6-6. Synchronizing Clock Switcher Circuit Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
67
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
The switch automatically selects ICLK during reset. When the clock monitor is on (CMON is set) and it
determines one of the clock sources is inactive (as indicated by the IOFF or EOFF signals), the circuit is
forced to select the active clock. There are no clocks for the inactive side of the synchronizer to properly
operate, so that side is forced deselected. However, the active side will not be selected until one to two
clock cycles after the IOFF or EOFF signal transitions.
6.4 Usage Notes
The ICG has several features which can provide protection to the microcontroller if properly used. There
are other features which can greatly simplify usage of the ICG if certain techniques are employed. This
section will describe several possible ways to use the ICG and its features. These techniques are not the
only ways to use the ICG, and may not be optimum for all environments. In any case, these techniques
should be used only as a template, and the user should modify them according to the application’s
requirements.
These notes include:
• Switching clock sources
• Enabling the clock monitor
• Using clock monitor interrupts
• Quantization error in DCO output
• Switching internal clock frequencies
• Nominal frequency settling time
• Improving frequency settling time
• Trimming frequency
6.4.1 Switching Clock Sources
Switching from one clock source to another requires both clock sources to be enabled and stable. A
simple flow requires:
1. Enable desired clock source
2. Wait for it to become stable
3. Switch clocks
4. Disable previous clock source
The key point to remember in this flow is that the clock source cannot be switched (CS cannot be written)
unless the desired clock is on and stable.
A short assembly code example of how to employ this flow is shown in Figure 6-7. This code is for
illustrative purposes only and does not represent valid syntax for any particular assembler.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
68
Freescale Semiconductor
Usage Notes
start
lda
#$13
loop
**
**
sta
icgcr
cmpa
bne
icgcr
loop
;Clock Switching Code Example
;This code switches from Internal to External clock
;Clock Monitor and interrupts are not enabled
;Mask for CS, ECGON, ECGS
;If switching from External to Internal, mask is $0C.
;Other code here, such as writing the COP, since ECGS may
;take some time to set
;Try to set CS, ECGON and clear ICGON. ICGON will not
;clear until CS is set, and CS will not set until
;ECGON and ECGS are set.
;Check to see if ECGS set, then CS set, then ICGON clear
;Keep looping until ICGON is clear.
Figure 6-7. Code Example for Switching Clock Sources
6.4.2 Enabling the Clock Monitor
Many applications require the clock monitor to determine if one of the clock sources has become inactive,
so the other can be used to recover from a potentially dangerous situation. Using the clock monitor
requires both clocks to be active (ECGON and ICGON both set). To enable the clock monitor, both clocks
also must be stable (ECGS and ICGS both set). This is to prevent the use of the clock monitor when a
clock is first turned on and potentially unstable.
Enabling the clock monitor and clock monitor interrupts requires a flow similar to this flow:
1. Enable the alternate clock source
2. Wait for both clock sources to be stable
3. Switch to the desired clock source if necessary
4. Enable the clock monitor
5. Enable clock monitor interrupts
These events must happen in sequence. A short assembly code example of how to employ this flow is
shown in Figure 6-8. This code is for illustrative purposes only and does not represent valid syntax for any
particular assembler.
start
lda
loop
**
sta
brset
cmpa
bne
;Clock Monitor Enabling Code Example
;This code turns on both clocks, selects the desired
; one, then turns on the Clock Monitor and Interrupts
#$AF
;Mask for CMIE, CMON, ICGON, ICGS, ECGON, ECGS
; If Internal Clock desired, mask is $AF
; If External Clock desired, mask is $BF
; If interrupts not desired mask is $2F int; $3F ext
**
;Other code here, such as writing the COP, since ECGS
; and ICGS may take some time to set.
icgcr
;Try to set CMIE. CMIE wont set until CMON set; CMON
; won’t set until ICGON, ICGS, ECGON, ECGS set.
6,ICGCR,error ;Verify CMF is not set
icgcr
;Check if ECGS set, then CMON set, then CMIE set
loop
;Keep looping until CMIE is set.
Figure 6-8. Code Example for Enabling the Clock Monitor
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
69
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
6.4.3 Clock Monitor Interrupts
The clock monitor circuit can be used to recover from perilous situations such as crystal loss. To use the
clock monitor effectively, these notes should be observed:
• Enable the clock monitor and clock monitor interrupts.
• The first statement in the clock monitor interrupt service routine should be a read to the ICG control
register (ICGCR) to verify that the clock monitor flag (CMF) is set. This is also the first step in
clearing the CMF bit.
• Never use BSET or BCLR instructions on the ICGCR, as this may inadvertently clear CMF. Only
use the BRSET and BRCLR instructions to check the CMF bit and not to check any other bits in
the ICGCR.
• When the clock monitor detects inactivity on the selected clock source (defined by the CS bit of the
ICG control register), the inactive clock is deselected automatically and the remaining active clock
is selected as the source for CGMXCLK. The interrupt service routine can use the state of the CS
bit to check which clock is inactive.
• When the clock monitor detects inactivity, the application may have been subjected to extreme
conditions which may have affected other circuits. The clock monitor interrupt service routine
should take any appropriate precautions.
6.4.4 Quantization Error in DCO Output
The digitally controlled oscillator (DCO) is comprised of three major sub-blocks:
1. Binary weighted divider
2. Variable-delay ring oscillator
3. Ring oscillator fine-adjust circuit
Each of these blocks affects the clock period of the internal clock (ICLK). Since these blocks are controlled
by the digital loop filter (DLF) outputs DDIV and DSTG, the output of the DCO can change only in
quantized steps as the DLF increments or decrements its output. The following sections describe how
each block will affect the output frequency.
6.4.4.1 Digitally Controlled Oscillator
The digitally controlled oscillator (DCO) is an inaccurate oscillator which generates the internal clock
(ICLK), whose clock period is dependent on the digital loop filter outputs (DSTG[7:0] and DDIV[3:0]).
Because of the digital nature of the DCO, the clock period of ICLK will change in quantized steps. This
will create a clock period difference or quantization error (Q-ERR) from one cycle to the next. Over several
cycles or for longer periods, this error is divided out until it reaches a minimum error of 0.202 percent to
0.368 percent. The dependence of this error on the DDIV[3:0] value and the number of cycles the error is
measured over is shown in Table 6-3.
6.4.4.2 Binary Weighted Divider
The binary weighted divider divides the output of the ring oscillator by a power of 2, specified by the DCO
divider control bits (DDIV[3:0]). DDIV maximizes at %1001 (values of %1010 through %1111 are
interpreted as %1001), which corresponds to a divide by 512. When DDIV is %0000, the ring oscillator’s
output is divided by 1. Incrementing DDIV by 1 will double the period; decrementing DDIV will halve the
period. The DLF cannot directly increment or decrement DDIV; DDIV is only incremented or decremented
when an addition or subtraction to DSTG carries or borrows.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
70
Freescale Semiconductor
Usage Notes
Table 6-3. Quantization Error in ICLK
DDIV[3:0]
ICLK Cycles
Bus Cycles
tICLK Q-ERR
%0000 (min)
4
1
1.61%–2.94%
%0000 (min)
≥ 32
≥8
0.202%–0.368%
%0001
4
1
0.806%–1.47%
%0001
≥ 16
≥4
0.202%–0.368%
%0010
4
1
0.403%–0.735%
%0010
≥8
≥2
0.202%–0.368%
%0011
≥4
≥1
0.202%–0.368%
%0100
≥2
≥1
0.202%–0.368%
%0101–%1001 (max)
≥1
≥1
0.202%–0.368%
6.4.4.3 Variable-Delay Ring Oscillator
The variable-delay ring oscillator’s period is adjustable from 17 to 31 stage delays, in increments of two,
based on the upper three DCO stage control bits (DSTG[7:5]). A DSTG[7:5] of %000 corresponds to 17
stage delays; DSTG[7:5] of %111 corresponds to 31 stage delays. Adjusting the DSTG[5] bit has a 6.45
percent to 11.8 percent effect on the output frequency. This also corresponds to the size correction made
when the frequency error is greater than ±15 percent. The value of the binary weighted divider does not
affect the relative change in output clock period for a given change in DSTG[7:5].
6.4.4.4 Ring Oscillator Fine-Adjust Circuit
The ring oscillator fine-adjust circuit causes the ring oscillator to effectively operate at non-integer
numbers of stage delays by operating at two different points for a variable number of cycles specified by
the lower five DCO stage control bits (DSTG[4:0]). For example, when DSTG[7:5] is %011, the ring
oscillator nominally operates at 23 stage delays. When DSTG[4:0] is %00000, the ring will always operate
at 23 stage delays. When DSTG[4:0] is %00001, the ring will operate at 25 stage delays for one of 32
cycles and at 23 stage delays for 31 of 32 cycles. Likewise, when DSTG[4:0] is %11111, the ring operates
at 25 stage delays for 31 of 32 cycles and at 23 stage delays for one of 32 cycles. When DSTG[7:5] is
%111, similar results are achieved by including a variable divide-by-two, so the ring operates at 31 stages
for some cycles and at 17 stage delays, with a divide-by-two for an effective 34 stage delays, for the
remainder of the cycles. Adjusting the DSTG[0] bit has a 0.202 percent to 0.368 percent effect on the
output clock period. This corresponds to the minimum size correction made by the DLF, and the inherent,
long-term quantization error in the output frequency.
6.4.5 Switching Internal Clock Frequencies
The frequency of the internal clock (ICLK) may need to be changed for some applications. For example,
if the reset condition does not provide the correct frequency, or if the clock is slowed down for a low-power
mode (or sped up after a low-power mode), the frequency must be changed by programming the internal
clock multiplier factor (N). The frequency of ICLK is N times the frequency of IBASE, which is 307.2 kHz
±25 percent.
Before switching frequencies by changing the N value, the clock monitor must be disabled. This is
because when N is changed, the frequency of the low-frequency base clock (IBASE) will change
proportionally until the digital loop filter has corrected the error. Since the clock monitor uses IBASE, it
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
71
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
could erroneously detect an inactive clock. The clock monitor cannot be re-enabled until the internal clock
is stable again (ICGS is set).
NOTE
There is no hardware mechanism to prevent changing bus frequency
dynamically. Be careful when changing bus frequency and consider the
impact on the system.
This flow is an example of how to change the clock frequency:
1. Verify there is no clock monitor interrupt by reading the CMF bit.
2. Turn off the clock monitor.
3. If desired, switch to the external clock (see 6.4.1 Switching Clock Sources).
4. Change the value of N.
5. Switch back to internal (see 6.4.1 Switching Clock Sources), if desired.
6. Turn on the clock monitor (see 6.4.2 Enabling the Clock Monitor), if desired.
6.4.6 Nominal Frequency Settling Time
Because the clock period of the internal clock (ICLK) is dependent on the digital loop filter outputs (DDIV
and DSTG) which cannot change instantaneously, ICLK will temporarily operate at an incorrect clock
period when any of the operating condition changes. This happens whenever the part is reset, the ICG
multiply factor (N) is changed, the ICG trim factor (TRIM) is changed, or the internal clock is enabled after
inactivity (STOP or disabled operation). The time that the ICLK takes to adjust to the correct period is
known as the settling time.
Settling time depends primarily on how many corrections it takes to change the clock period, and the
period of each correction. Since the corrections require four periods of the low-frequency base clock
(4*tIBASE), and since ICLK is N (the ICG multiply factor for the desired frequency) times faster than IBASE,
each correction takes 4*N*tICLK. The period of ICLK, however, will vary as the corrections occur.
6.4.6.1 Settling to Within 15 Percent
When the error is greater than 15 percent, the filter takes eight corrections to double or halve the clock
period. Due to how the DCO increases or decreases the clock period, the total period of these eight
corrections is approximately 11 times the period of the fastest correction. (If the corrections were perfectly
linear, the total period would be 11.5 times the minimum period; however, the ring must be slightly
non-linear.) Therefore, the total time it takes to double or halve the clock period is 44*N*tICLKFAST.
If the clock period needs more than doubled or halved, the same relationship applies, only for each time
the clock period needs doubled, the total number of cycles doubles.
That is, when transitioning from fast to slow:
• Going from the initial speed to half speed takes 44*N*tICLKFAST
• From half speed to quarter speed takes 88*N*tICLKFAST
• Going from quarter speed to eighth speed takes 176*N*tICLKFAST, and so on.
This series can be expressed as (2x–1)*44*N*tICLKFAST, where x is the number of times the speed needs
doubled or halved. Since 2x happens to be equal to tICLKSLOW/tICLKFAST, the equation reduces to
44*N*(tICLKSLOW-tICLKFAST). Note that increasing speed takes much longer than decreasing speed since
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
72
Freescale Semiconductor
Usage Notes
N is higher. This can be expressed in terms of the initial clock period (t1) minus the final clock period (t2)
as such:
t
= abs [ 44N ( t – t ) ]
15
1 2
6.4.6.2 Settling to Within 5 Percent
Once the clock period is within 15 percent of the desired clock period, the filter starts making smaller
adjustments. When between 15 percent and 5 percent error, each correction will adjust the clock period
between 1.61 percent and 2.94 percent. In this mode, a maximum of eight corrections will be required to
get to less than 5 percent error. Since the clock period is relatively close to desired, each correction takes
approximately the same period of time, or 4*tIBASE. At this point, the internal clock stable bit (ICGS) will
be set and the clock frequency is usable, although the error will be as high as 5 percent. The total time to
this point is:
t
5
= abs [ 44N ( t – t ) ] + 32t
1 2
IBASE
6.4.6.3 Total Settling Time
Once the clock period is within 5 percent of the desired clock period, the filter starts making minimum
adjustments. In this mode, each correction will adjust the frequency between 0.202 percent and 0.368
percent. A maximum of 24 corrections will be required to get to the minimum error. Each correction takes
approximately the same period of time or 4*tIBASE. Added to the corrections for 15 percent to 5 percent,
this makes 32 corrections (128*tIBASE) to get from 15 percent to the minimum error. The total time to the
minimum error is:
t
tot
= abs [ 44N ( t – t ) ] + 128t
1 2
IBASE
The equations for t15, t5, and ttot are dependent on the actual initial and final clock periods t1 and t2, not
the nominal. This means the variability in the ICLK frequency due to process, temperature, and voltage
must be considered. Additionally, other process factors and noise can affect the actual tolerances of the
points at which the filter changes modes. This means a worst case adjustment of up to 35 percent (ICLK
clock period tolerance plus 10 percent) must be added. This adjustment can be reduced with trimming.
Table 6-4 shows some typical values for settling time.
Table 6-4. Typical Settling Time Examples
t1
t2
N
t15
t5
ttot
1/ (6.45 MHz)
1/ (25.8 MHz)
84
430 µs
535 µs
850 µs
1/ (25.8 MHz)
1/ (6.45 MHz)
21
107 µs
212 µs
525 µs
1/ (25.8 MHz)
1/ (307.2 kHz)
1
141 µs
246 µs
560 µs
1/ (307.2 kHz)
1/ (25.8 MHz)
84
11.9 ms
12.0 ms
12.3 ms
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
73
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
6.4.7 Improving Settling Time
The settling time of the internal clock generator can be vastly improved if an external clock source can be
used during the settling time. When the internal clock generator is disabled (ICGON is low), the DDIV[3:0]
and DSTG[7:0] bits can be written. Then, when the internal clock generator is re-enabled, the clock period
will automatically start at the point written in the DDIV and DSTG bits.
Since a change in the DDIV and DSTG bits only cause a change in the clock period relative to the starting
point, the starting point must first be captured. The initial clock period can be expressed as in the next
example, where tX is a process, temperature, and voltage dependent constant and DDIV1 and DSTG1
are the values of DDIV and DSTG when operating at t1.
t
= t ⋅2
1
X
DDIV1
⋅ DSTG1
Finding the new values for DDIV and DSTG is easy if the new clock period is a binary multiple or fraction
of the original. In this case, DSTG is unchanged and DDIV2 is DDIV1 + log2(t2/t1).
If the new clock period is not a binary multiple or fraction of the original, both DSTG and DDIV may need
to change according to these equations:
log ( t ⁄ t )
2 1
DVFACT = int --------------------------log ( 2 )
DDIV2 = DDIV1 + DVFACT
(t ⁄ t )
2 1
DSFACT = ---------------------------------------------------( DDIV2 – DDIV1 )
2
DSTG2 = DSFACT ⋅ DSTG1
If DSTG2 is greater than 255:
DDIV2 = DDIV2 + 1
--------------------DSTG2 = DSTG2
2
The software required to do this is relatively simple, since most of the math can be done before coding
because the initial and final clock periods are known. An example of how to code this in assembly code
is shown in Figure 6-9. This example is for illustrative purposes only and does not represent a valid syntax
for any particular assembler.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
74
Freescale Semiconductor
Usage Notes
;DDIV and DSTG modification code example
;Changes DDIV and DSTG according to the initial and
; desired clock period values
;Requires ICGON to be clear (disabled)
;User must previously calculate DVFACT and STFACT by
; the equations listed in the specification
;Modifies X and A registers
start
store
exit
lda
cmp
lda
add
sta
lda
icgcr
#13
#dvfact
icgdvr
icgdvr
#stfact
ldx
mul
rola
rolx
bcc
rorx
inc
stx
lda
cmp
bhi
lda
sta
jmp
jmp
icgdsr
store
icgdsr
icgdvr
#09
exit
#09
icgdvr
error
enable
;Verify ICGON clear (this will require
; CMIE,CMF,CMON,ICGON,ICGS clear and CS,ECGON,ECGS set)
;Add the DDIV factor (calculated before
; coding by the DDIV2 equation)
;Load the DSTG factor (calculated before coding and
; multiplied by 128 to make it 0-255 for maximum precision
;Load current stage register contents
;Multiply factor times current value
;Since factor was multiplied by 128,
; result is x6-x0:a7, so put it all in X
;If result is >255, rolx will set carry
; so divide result by two and
; add one to DDIV
;Store value
;Test to see if DDIV too high or low
;Valid range 0-9; too low is FF/FE; too high is 0A/0B
;If DDIV is 0-9, you’re almost done
;Otherwise, maximize period and execute error code
;Jump to code which turns on desired
;clock, clock monitor, interrupts, etc.
Figure 6-9. Code Example for Writing DDIV and DSTG
6.4.8 Trimming Frequency on the Internal Clock Generator
The unadjusted frequency of the low-frequency base clock (IBASE), when the comparators in the
frequency comparator indicate zero error, will vary as much as ±25 percent due to process, temperature,
and voltage dependencies. These dependencies are in the voltage and current references, the offset of
the comparators, and the internal capacitor. The voltage and temperature dependencies have been
designed to be a maximum of approximately ±1 percent error. The process dependencies account for the
rest.
Fortunately, for an individual part, the process dependencies are constant. An individual part can operate
at approximately ±2 percent variance from its unadjusted operating point over the entire specification
range of the application. If the unadjusted operating point can be changed, the entire variance can be
limited to ±2 percent.
The method of changing the unadjusted operating point is by changing the size of the capacitor. This
capacitor is designed with 639 equally sized units, 384 of which are always connected. The remaining
255 units are put in by adjusting the ICG trim factor (TRIM). The default value for TRIM is $80, or 128
units, making the default capacitor size 512. Each unit added or removed will adjust the output frequency
by about ±0.195 percent of the unadjusted frequency (adding to TRIM will decrease frequency).
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
75
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
Therefore, the frequency of IBASE can be changed to ±25 percent of its unadjusted value, which is
enough to cancel the process variability mentioned before.
The best way to trim the internal clock is to use the timer to measure the width of an input pulse on an
input capture pin (this pulse must be supplied by the application and should be as long or wide as
possible). Considering the prescale value of the timer and the theoretical (zero error) frequency of the bus
(307.2 kHz *N/4), the error can be calculated. This error, expressed as a percentage, can be divided by
0.195 percent and the resultant factor added or subtracted from TRIM. This process should be repeated
to eliminate any residual error.
NOTE
It is recommended that the user preserve a copy of the contents of the ICG
trim register (ICGTR) in non-volitale memory.
Address $7FEF is reserved for an optional factory-determined value.
Consult with a local Freescale representative for more information and
availability of this option.
6.5 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
6.5.1 Wait Mode
The ICG remains active in wait mode. If enabled, the ICG interrupt to the CPU can bring the MCU out of
wait mode.
In some applications, low-power consumption is desired in wait mode and a high-frequency clock is not
needed. In these applications, reduce power consumption by either selecting a low-frequency external
clock and turning the internal clock generator off, or reducing the bus frequency by minimizing the ICG
multiplier factor (N) before executing the WAIT instruction.
6.5.2 Stop Mode
The ICG is disabled in stop mode. Upon execution of the STOP instruction, all ICG activity will cease and
the output clocks (CGMXCLK and CGMOUT) will be held low. Power consumption will be minimal.
The STOP instruction does not affect the values in the ICG registers. Normal execution will resume after
the MCU exits stop mode.
6.6 Configuration Register Option
One configuration register option affects the functionality of the ICG: EXTSLOW (slow external clock).
All configuration register options will have a default setting. Refer to Chapter 3 Configuration Register
(CONFIG) on how the configuration register is used.
6.6.1 EXTSLOW
Slow external clock (EXTSLOW), when set, will decrease the drive strength of the oscillator amplifier,
enabling low-frequency crystal operation (30 kHz–100 kHz). When clear, EXTSLOW enables high
frequency crystal operation (1 MHz to 8 MHz).
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
76
Freescale Semiconductor
I/O Registers
EXTSLOW, when set, also configures the clock monitor to expect an external clock source that is slower
than the low-frequency base clock (60 Hz–307.2 kHz). When EXTSLOW is clear, the clock monitor will
expect an external clock faster than the low-frequency base clock (307.2 kHz–32 MHz).
The default state for this option is clear.
6.7 I/O Registers
The ICG contains five registers, summarized in Figure 6-10. These registers are:
• ICG control register, ICGCR
• ICG multiplier register, ICGMR
• ICG trim register, ICGTR
• ICG DCO divider control register, ICGDVR
• ICG DCO stage control register, ICGDSR
Several of the bits in these registers have interaction where the state of one bit may force another bit to
a particular state or prevent another bit from being set or cleared. A summary of this interaction is shown
in Table 6-5.
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
$0036
Internal Clock Generator Read:
Control Register (ICGCR) Write:
See page 78. Reset:
$0037
Internal Clock Generator Read:
Multiplier Register (ICGMR) Write:
See page 80. Reset:
$0038
$0039
$003A
Internal Clock Generator Read:
Trim Register (ICGTR) Write:
See page 80. Reset:
ICG DCO Divider Control Read:
Register (ICGDVR) Write:
See page 81. Reset:
ICG DCO Stage Register Read:
(ICGDSR) Write:
See page 81. Reset:
CMIE
6
CMF
5
4
3
CMON
CS
ICGON
2
ICGS
1
ECGON
Bit 0
ECGS
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
R
N6
N5
N4
N3
N2
N1
N0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
TRIM7
TRIM6
TRIM5
TRIM4
TRIM3
TRIM2
TRIM1
TRIM0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
DDIV3
DDIV2
DDIV1
DDIV0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
U
DSTG7
DSTG6
DSTG5
DSTG4
DSTG3
DSTG2
DSTG1
DSTG0
Unaffected by reset
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
U = Unaffected
Figure 6-10. ICG I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
77
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
Table 6-5. ICG Module Register Bit Interaction Summary
Register Big Results for Given Condition
Condition
CMIE CMF CMON CS ICGON ICGS ECGON ECGS N[6:0] TRIM[7:0] DDIV[3:0] DSTG[7:0]
Reset
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
$15
$80
—
—
CMF = 1
—
(1)
1
—
1
—
1
—
uw
uw
uw
uw
CMON = 0
0
0
(0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CMON = 1
—
—
(1)
—
1
—
1
—
uw
uw
uw
uw
CS = 0
—
—
—
(0)
1
—
—
—
—
—
uw
uw
CS = 1
—
—
—
(1)
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
ICGON = 0
0
0
0
1
(0)
0
1
—
—
—
—
—
ICGON = 1
—
—
—
—
(1)
—
—
—
—
—
uw
uw
ICGS = 0
us
—
us
uc
—
(0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
ECGON = 0
0
0
0
0
1
—
(0)
0
—
—
uw
uw
ECGS = 0
us
—
us
us
—
—
—
(0)
—
—
—
—
IOFF = 1
—
1*
(1)
1
(1)
0
(1)
—
uw
uw
uw
uw
EOFF = 1
—
1*
(1)
0
(1)
—
(1)
0
uw
uw
uw
uw
N = written
(0)
(0)
(0)
—
—
0*
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRIM = written
(0)
(0)
(0)
—
—
0*
—
—
—
—
—
—
— Register bit is unaffected by the given condition.
0, 1 Register bit is forced clear or set, respectively, in the given condition.
0*, 1* Register bit is temporarily forced clear or set, respectively, in the given condition.
(0), (1) Register bit must be clear or set, respectively, for the given condition to occur.
us, uc, uw Register bit cannot be set, cleared, or written, respectively, in the given condition.
6.7.1 ICG Control Register
The ICG control register (ICGCR) contains the control and status bits for the internal clock generator,
external clock generator, and clock monitor as well as the clock select and interrupt enable bits.
Address: $0036
Bit 7
Read:
Write:
Reset:
CMIE
0
6
CMF
5
4
3
CMON
CS
ICGON
0
0
1
0
2
ICGS
0
1
ECGON
0
Bit 0
ECGS
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 6-11. ICG Control Register (ICGCR)
CMIE — Clock Monitor Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables clock monitor interrupts. An interrupt will occur when both CMIE and CMF
are set. CMIE can be set when the CMON bit has been set for at least one cycle. CMIE is forced clear
when CMON is clear or during reset.
1 = Clock monitor interrupts enabled
0 = Clock monitor interrupts disabled
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
78
Freescale Semiconductor
I/O Registers
CMF — Clock Monitor Interrupt Flag
This read-only bit is set when the clock monitor determines that either ICLK or ECLK becomes inactive
and the CMON bit is set. This bit is cleared by first reading the bit while it is set, followed by writing the
bit low. This bit is forced clear when CMON is clear or during reset.
1 = Either ICLK or ECLK has become inactive.
0 = ICLK and ECLK have not become inactive since the last read of the ICGCR or the clock monitor
is disabled.
CMON — Clock Monitor On Bit
This read/write bit enables the clock monitor. CMON can be set when both ICLK and ECLK have been
on and stable for at least one bus cycle (ICGON, ECGON, ICGS, and ECGS are all set). CMON is
forced set when CMF is set, to avoid inadvertent clearing of CMF. CMON is forced clear when either
ICGON or ECGON is clear or during reset.
1 = Clock monitor output enabled
0 = Clock monitor output disabled
CS — Clock Select Bit
This read/write bit determines which clock will generate the oscillator output clock (CGMXCLK). This
bit can be set when ECGON and ECGS have been set for at least one bus cycle and can be cleared
when ICGON and ICGS have been set for at least one bus cycle. This bit is forced set when the clock
monitor determines the internal clock (ICLK) is inactive or when ICGON is clear. This bit is forced clear
when the clock monitor determines that the external clock (ECLK) is inactive, when ECGON is clear,
or during reset.
1 = External clock (ECLK) sources CGMXCLK
0 = Internal clock (ICLK) sources CGMXCLK
ICGON — Internal Clock Generator On Bit
This read/write bit enables the internal clock generator. ICGON can be cleared when the CS bit has
been set and the CMON bit has been clear for at least one bus cycle. ICGON is forced set when the
CMON bit is set, the CS bit is clear, or during reset.
1 = Internal clock generator enabled
0 = Internal clock generator disabled
ICGS — Internal Clock Generator Stable Bit
This read-only bit indicates when the internal clock generator has determined that the internal clock
(ICLK) is within about 5 percent of the desired value. This bit is forced clear when the clock monitor
determines the ICLK is inactive, when ICGON is clear, when the ICG multiplier factor is written, or
during reset.
1 = Internal clock is within 5 percent of the desired value.
0 = Internal clock may not be within 5 percent of the desired value.
ECGON — External Clock Generator On Bit
This read/write bit enables the external clock generator. ECGON can be cleared when the CS and
CMON bits have been clear for at least one bus cycle. ECGON is forced set when the CMON bit or the
CS bit is set. ECGON is forced clear during reset.
1 = External clock generator enabled
0 = External clock generator disabled
ECGS — External Clock Generator Stable Bit
This read-only bit indicates when at least 4096 external clock (ECLK) cycles have elapsed since the
external clock generator was enabled. This is not an assurance of the stability of ECLK but is meant
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
79
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
to provide a startup delay. This bit is forced clear when the clock monitor determines ECLK is inactive,
when ECGON is clear, or during reset.
1 = 4096 ECLK cycles have elapsed since ECGON was set.
0 = External cock is unstable, inactive, or disabled.
6.7.2 ICG Multiplier Register
Address: $0037
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
N6
N5
N4
N3
N2
N1
N0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
R
= Reserved
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 6-12. ICG Multiplier Register (ICGMR)
N6–N0 — ICG Multiplier Factor Bits
These read/write bits change the multiplier used by the internal
clock generator. The internal clock (ICLK) will be
(307.2 kHz ±25 percent) * N. A value of $00 in this register is interpreted the same as a value of $01.
This register cannot be written when the CMON bit is set. Reset sets this factor to $15 (decimal 21) for
default frequency of 6.45 MHz ±25 percent (1.613 MHz ±25 percent bus).
6.7.3 ICG Trim Register
Address: $0038
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
TRIM7
TRIM6
TRIM5
TRIM4
TRIM3
TRIM2
TRIM1
TRIM0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 6-13. ICG Trim Register (ICGTR)
TRIM7–TRIM0 — ICG Trim Factor Bits
These read/write bits change the size of the internal capacitor used by the internal clock generator. By
testing the frequency of the internal clock and incrementing or decrementing this factor accordingly,
the accuracy of the internal clock can be improved to ±2 percent. Incrementing this register by 1
decreases the frequency by 0.195 percent of the unadjusted value. Decrementing this register by one
increases the frequency by 0.195 percent. This register cannot be written when the CMON bit is set.
Reset sets these bits to $80, centering the range of possible adjustment.
NOTE
It is recommended that the user preserve a copy of the contents of the ICG
trim register (ICGTR) in non-volitale memory.
Address $7FEF is reserved for an optional factory-determined ICG trim
value. Consult with a local Freescale representative for more information
and availability of this option.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
80
Freescale Semiconductor
I/O Registers
6.7.4 ICG DCO Divider Register
Address: $0039
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
DDIV3
DDIV2
DDIV1
DDIV0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
U
Read:
Write:
Reset:
R
= Reserved
U = Unaffected
Figure 6-14. ICG DCO Divider Register (ICGDVR)
DDIV3–DDIV0 — ICG DCO Divider Control Bits
These bits indicate the number of divide-by-twos (DDIV) that follow the digitally controlled oscillator.
Incrementing DDIV will add another divide-by-two, doubling the period (halving the frequency).
Decrementing has the opposite effect. DDIV cannot be written when ICGON is set to prevent
inadvertent frequency shifting. When ICGON is set, DDIV is controlled by the digital loop filter. The
range of valid values for DDIV is from $0 to $9. Values of $A–$F are interpreted the same as $9. Since
the DCO is active during reset, reset has no effect on DSTG and the value may vary.
6.7.5 ICG DCO Stage Register
Address: $003A
Read:
Write:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DSTG7
DSTG6
DSTG5
DSTG4
DSTG3
DSTG2
DSTG1
DSTG0
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 6-15. ICG DCO Stage Register (ICGDSR)
DSTG7–DSTG0 — ICG DCO Stage Control Bits
These bits indicate the number of stages DSTG (above the minimum) in the digitally controlled
oscillator. The total number of stages is approximately equal to $1FF, so changing DSTG from $00 to
$FF will approximately double the period. Incrementing DSTG will increase the period (decrease the
frequency) by 0.202 percent to 0.368 percent (decrementing has the opposite effect). DSTG cannot
be written when ICGON is set to prevent inadvertent frequency shifting. When ICGON is set, DSTG is
controlled by the digital loop filter. Since the DCO is active during reset, reset has no effect on DSTG
and the value may vary.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
81
Internal Clock Generator Module (ICG)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
82
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 7
Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI)
7.1 Introduction
This section describes the maskable external interrupt (IRQ) input and six independently maskable
keyboard wakeup interrupt pins.
7.2 Features
Features of the KBI include:
• Dedicated external interrupt pin (IRQ)
• Six keyboard interrupt pins with separate keyboard interrupt enable bits and one keyboard interrupt
mask
• Internal pullup resistor
• Hysteresis buffer
• Programmable edge-only or edge- and level-interrupt sensitivity
• Automatic interrupt acknowledge
7.3 Functional Description
This section provides a functional description of the keyboard/external interrupt module (KBI).
7.3.1 External Interrupt
A logic 0 applied to the external interrupt pin (IRQ) can latch a CPU interrupt request. Figure 7-2 shows
the structure of the external (IRQ) interrupt of the KBI module.
A logic 0 applied to one or more of the keyboard interrupt pins can latch a CPU interrupt request.
Figure 7-5 shows the structure of the keyboard interrupts of the KBI module
See Figure 7-3 for a summary of the interrupt and keyboard input/output (I/O) registers.
Interrupt signals on the IRQ pin are latched into the IRQ1 latch. Keyboard interrupts are latched in the
keyboard interrupt latch. An interrupt latch remains set until one of these actions occurs:
• Vector fetch — A vector fetch automatically generates an interrupt acknowledge signal that clears
IRQ1 latch and keyboard interrupt latch.
• Software clear — Software can clear an interrupt latch by writing to the appropriate acknowledge
bit in the interrupt status and control register (INTKBSCR). Writing a 1 to the ACKI bit clears the
IRQ1 latch. Writing a 1 to the ACKK bit clears the keyboard interrupt latch.
• Reset — A reset automatically clears both interrupt latches.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
83
Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI)
INTERNAL BUS
M68HC08 CPU
ARITHMETIC/LOGIC
UNIT (ALU)
PTA7(2)
PTA6/KBD6(2) (3)
PTA5/KBD5(2) (3)
CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 32 BYTES
PTA
SECURITY
MODULE
DDRA
CPU
REGISTERS
COMPUTER OPERATING
PROPERLY MODULE
DDRB
PTB
LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT
MODULE
MONITOR ROM — 768 BYTES
PTA3/KBD3(2) (3)
PTA2/KBD2(2) (3)
PTA1/KBD1(2) (3)
PTA0(2)
USER FLASH — 2031 BYTES
USER RAM — 128 BYTES
PTA4/KBD4(2) (3)
2-CHANNEL TIMER
MODULE
PTB3/TCLK
PTB2/TCH0
PTB1
PTB0/MCLK
USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 14 BYTES
OSC2
OSC1
SOFTWARE SELECTABLE
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
MODULE
VCC
MODE
RST(1)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
IRQ(1)
KEYBOARD/INTERRUPT
MODULE
ENABLE
DATA
BAND
UHF
TRANSMITTER
RFOUT
GNDRF
REXT
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
XTAL1
XTAL0
DATACLK
VDD
CFSK
POWER
VSS
1. Pin contains integrated pullup resistor
2. High current sink pin
3. Pin contains software selectable pullup resistor
Figure 7-1. Block Diagram Highlighting KBI Block and Pins
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
84
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
ACKI
INTERNAL ADDRESS BUS
RESET
TO CPU FOR
BIL/BIH
INSTRUCTIONS
VECTOR
FETCH
DECODER
VDD
INTERNAL
PULLUP
DEVICE
VDD
IRQ1F
D
CLR
Q
CK
IRQ
IRQ1
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
SYNCHRONIZER
IRQ1
LATCH
IMASKI
KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
IRQ1/KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
MODEI
HIGH
VOLTAGE
DETECT
TO MODE
SELECT
LOGIC
Figure 7-2. IRQ Block Diagram
Addr.
$001A
$001B
Register Name
Bit 7
6
IRQ and Keyboard Status Read:
and Control Register Write:
(INTKBSCR)
See page 90. Reset:
IRQ1F
0
R
ACKI
0
Keyboard Interrupt Enable Read:
Register (INTKBIER) Write:
See page 91. Reset:
0
0
5
4
3
2
IMASKI
MODEI
KEYF
0
R
ACKK
0
0
0
0
KBIE6
KBIE5
KBIE4
0
0
= Unimplemented
1
Bit 0
IMASKK
MODEK
0
0
0
KBIE3
KBIE2
KBIE1
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
0
0
Figure 7-3. IRQ and Keyboard I/O Register Summary
The IRQ1 pin and keyboard interrupt pins are falling-edge triggered and are software-configurable to be
both falling-edge and low-level triggered. The MODEI and MODEK bits in the INTKBSCR controls the
triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin and keyboard interrupt pins.
When an interrupt pin is edge-triggered only, the interrupt latch remains set until a vector fetch, software
clear, or reset occurs.
When an interrupt pin is both falling-edge and low-level-triggered, the interrupt latch remains set until both
of these occur:
• Vector fetch or software clear
• Return of the interrupt pin to logic 1
The vector fetch or software clear may occur before or after the interrupt pin returns to logic 1. As long as
the pin is low, the interrupt request remains pending. A reset will clear the latch, the MODEI and MODEK
control bits, thereby clearing the interrupt even if the pin stays low.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
85
Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI)
When set, the IMASKI and IMASKK bits in the INTKBSCR mask all external interrupt requests. A latched
interrupt request is not presented to the interrupt priority logic unless the corresponding IMASK<x> bit is
clear.
NOTE
The interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register (CCR) masks all
interrupt requests, including external interrupt requests. See Figure 7-4.
FROM RESET
YES
I BIT SET?
NO
INTERRUPT?
YES
NO
STACK CPU REGISTERS
SET I BIT
LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR
FETCH NEXT
INSTRUCTION
SWI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
NO
RTI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS
NO
EXECUTE INSTRUCTION
Figure 7-4. IRQ Interrupt Flowchart
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
86
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
7.3.2 IRQ Pin
A logic 0 on the IRQ pin can latch an interrupt request into the IRQ1 latch. A vector fetch, software clear,
or reset clears the IRQ1 latch. If the MODEI bit is set, the IRQ pin is both falling-edge sensitive and
low-level sensitive. With MODEI set, both of these actions must occur to clear the IRQ1 latch:
• Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an interrupt acknowledge signal to clear
the latch. Software may generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a 1 to the ACKI bit in
the IRQ and keyboard status and control register (INTKBSCR). The ACKI bit is useful in
applications that poll the IRQ pin and require software to clear the IRQ1 latch. Writing to the ACKI
bit can also prevent spurious interrupts due to noise. Setting ACKI does not affect subsequent
transitions on the IRQ pin. A falling edge on IRQ that occurs after writing to the ACKI bit latches
another interrupt request. If the IRQ1 mask bit, IMASKI, is clear, the CPU loads the program
counter with the vector address at locations $FFFA and $FFFB.
• Return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 — As long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0, the IRQ1 latch remains set.
The vector fetch or software clear and the return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 can occur in any order. The
interrupt request remains pending as long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0. A reset will clear the latch and the
MODEI control bit, thereby clearing the interrupt even if the pin stays low.
If the MODEI bit is clear, the IRQ pin is falling-edge sensitive only. With MODEI clear, a vector fetch or
software clear immediately clears the IRQ1 latch.The IRQ1F bit in the INTKBSCR register can be used
to check for pending interrupts. The IRQ1F bit is not affected by the IMASKI bit, which makes it useful in
applications where polling is preferred.
Use the BIH or BIL instruction to read the logic level on the IRQ pin.
NOTE
When using the level-sensitive interrupt trigger, avoid false interrupts by
masking interrupt requests in the interrupt routine.
INTERNAL BUS
KBD1
ACKK
VDD
VECTOR FETCH
DECODER
KEYF
RESET
.
TO PULLUP
ENABLE
D
CLR
Q
SYNCHRONIZER
.
CK
KB1IE
KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
.
KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT LATCH
KBD6
TO PULLUP
ENABLE
IMASKK
MODEK
IRQ1/KEYBOARD
IRQ1
INTERRUPT
INTERRUPT REQUEST
REQUEST
KB6IE
Figure 7-5. Keyboard Interrupt Block Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
87
Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI)
7.3.3 KBI Module During Break Interrupts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether the IRQ1 or keyboard interrupt latches can be
cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the break flag control register (BFCR) enables software
to clear the latches during the break state. (See 10.7.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register.)
To allow software to clear the IRQ1 or keyboard latches during a break interrupt, write a 1 to the BCFE
bit. If a latch is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect the latch during the break state, write a 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at 0 (its default state),
writing to the ACKI or ACKK bits in the IRQ and keyboard status and control register during the break
state has no effect on the IRQ1 or keyboard latches.
7.3.4 Keyboard Interrupt Pins
Writing to the KBIE6–KBIE1 bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register independently enables or
disables each port A pin as a keyboard interrupt pin. Enabling a keyboard interrupt pin also enables its
internal pullup device. A logic 0 applied to an enabled keyboard interrupt pin latches an IRQ1/keyboard
interrupt request.
An IRQ1/keyboard interrupt is latched when one or more keyboard pins goes low after all were high. The
MODEK bit in the keyboard status and control register controls the triggering mode of the keyboard
interrupt.
• If the keyboard interrupt is edge-sensitive only, a falling edge on a keyboard pin does not latch an
interrupt request if another keyboard pin is already low. To prevent losing an interrupt request on
one pin because another pin is still low, software can disable the latter pin while it is low.
• If the keyboard interrupt is falling edge- and low level-sensitive, an interrupt request is present as
long as any keyboard pin is low.
If the MODEK bit is set, the keyboard interrupt pins are both falling edge- and low level-sensitive, and both
of these actions must occur to clear a keyboard interrupt request:
• Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an interrupt acknowledge signal to clear
the interrupt request. Software may generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a 1 to the
ACKK bit in the keyboard status and control register (INTKBSCR). The ACKK bit is useful in
applications that poll the keyboard interrupt pins and require software to clear the keyboard
interrupt request. Writing to the ACKK bit prior to leaving an interrupt service routine also can
prevent spurious interrupts due to noise. Setting ACKK does not affect subsequent transitions on
the keyboard interrupt pins. A falling edge that occurs after writing to the ACKK bit latches another
interrupt request. If the keyboard interrupt mask bit, IMASKK, is clear, the CPU loads the program
counter with the vector address at locations $FFFA and $FFFB.
• Return of all enabled keyboard interrupt pins to logic 1. As long as any enabled keyboard interrupt
pin is at logic 0, the keyboard interrupt remains set.
The vector fetch or software clear and the return of all enabled keyboard interrupt pins to logic 1 may occur
in any order.
If the MODEK bit is clear, the keyboard interrupt pin is falling edge-sensitive only. With MODEK clear, a
vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the keyboard interrupt request.
Reset clears the keyboard interrupt request and the MODEK bit, clearing the interrupt request even if a
keyboard interrupt pin stays at logic 0.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
88
Freescale Semiconductor
Low-Power Modes
The keyboard flag bit (KEYF) in the IRQ and keyboard status and control register can be used to see if a
pending interrupt exists. The KEYF bit is not affected by the keyboard interrupt mask bit (IMASKK) which
makes it useful in applications where polling is preferred.
To determine the logic level on a keyboard interrupt pin, use the data direction register to configure the
pin as an input and read the data register.
NOTE
Setting a keyboard interrupt enable bit (KBIE<x>) forces the corresponding
keyboard interrupt pin to be an input, overriding the data direction register.
However, the data direction register bit must be a 0 for software to read the
pin.
7.3.5 Keyboard Initialization
When a keyboard interrupt pin is enabled, it takes time for the internal pullup to reach a logic 1. Therefore,
a false interrupt can occur as soon as the pin is enabled.
To prevent a false interrupt on keyboard initialization:
1. Mask keyboard interrupts by setting the IMASKK bit in the keyboard status and control register.
2. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register.
3. Write to the ACKK bit in the keyboard status and control register to clear any false interrupts.
4. Clear the IMASKK bit.
An interrupt signal on an edge-triggered pin can be acknowledged immediately after enabling the pin. An
interrupt signal on an edge- and level-triggered interrupt pin must be acknowledged after a delay that
depends on the external load.
Another way to avoid a false interrupt:
1. Configure the keyboard pins as outputs by setting the appropriate DDRA bits in data direction
register A.
2. Write 1s to the appropriate port A data register bits.
3. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register.
7.4 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
7.4.1 Wait Mode
The IRQ1/keyboard interrupts remain active in wait mode. Clearing the IMASKI or IMASKK bits in the IRQ
and keyboard status and control register enables keyboard interrupt requests to bring the MCU out of wait
mode.
7.4.2 Stop Mode
The IRQ1/keyboard interrupt remains active in stop mode. Clearing the IMASKI or IMASKK bit in the IRQ
and keyboard status and control register enables keyboard interrupt requests to bring the MCU out of stop
mode.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
89
Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI)
7.5 I/O Registers
These registers control and monitor operation of the keyboard/external interrupt module:
• IRQ and keyboard status and control register, INTKBSCR
• Keyboard interrupt enable register, KBIER
7.5.1 IRQ and Keyboard Status and Control Register
The IRQ and keyboard status and control register (INTKBSCR) controls and monitors operation of the
keyboard/external interrupt module. The INTKBSCR has these functions:
• Flags the keyboard interrupt requests
• Acknowledges the keyboard interrupt requests
• Masks the keyboard interrupt requests
• Shows the state of the IRQ1 interrupt flag
• Clears the IRQ interrupt latch
• Masks the IRQ interrupt request
• Controls the triggering sensitivity of the keyboard and IRQ interrupt pins
Address: $001A
Bit 7
6
Read:
IRQ1F
0
Write:
R
ACKI
Reset:
0
0
R
= Reserved
5
4
IMASKI
MODEI
0
0
3
2
KEYF
0
R
ACKK
0
0
1
Bit 0
IMASKK
MODEK
0
0
Figure 7-6. IRQ and Keyboard Status and Control Register (INTKBSCR)
IRQ1F — IRQ Flag Bit
This read-only status bit is high when the IRQ interrupt is pending.
1 = IRQ interrupt pending
0 = IRQ interrupt not pending
ACKI — IRQ Interrupt Request Acknowledge Bit
Writing a 1 to this write-only bit clears the IRQ latch. ACKI always reads as 0. Reset clears ACKI.
IMASKI — IRQ Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a 1 to this read/write bit disables IRQ interrupt requests. Reset clears IMASKI.
1 = IRQ interrupt requests disabled
0 = IRQ interrupt requests enabled
MODEI — IRQ Triggering Sensitivity Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin. Reset clears MODEI.
1 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = interrupt requests on falling edges only
KEYF — Keyboard Flag Bit
This read-only bit is set when a keyboard interrupt is pending. Reset clears the KEYF bit.
1 = Keyboard interrupt pending
0 = No keyboard interrupt pending
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
90
Freescale Semiconductor
I/O Registers
ACKK — Keyboard Acknowledge Bit
Writing a 1 to this write-only bit clears the keyboard interrupt request. ACKK always reads as 0. Reset
clears ACKK.
IMASKK — Keyboard Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a 1 to this read/write bit prevents the output of the keyboard interrupt mask from generating
interrupt requests. Reset clears the IMASKK bit.
1 = Keyboard interrupt requests masked
0 = Keyboard interrupt requests not masked
MODEK — Keyboard Triggering Sensitivity Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the keyboard interrupt pins. Reset clears
MODEK.
1 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges only
7.5.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register
The keyboard interrupt enable register (INTKBIER) enables or disables each port A pin to operate as a
keyboard interrupt pin.
Address: $001B
Bit 7
Read:
0
Write:
Reset:
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
KBIE6
KBIE5
KBIE4
KBIE3
KBIE2
KBIE1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 7-7. Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register (INTKBIER)
KBIE6–KBIE1 — Keyboard Interrupt Enable Bits
Each of these read/write bits enables the corresponding keyboard interrupt pin to latch interrupt
requests. These bits also enable the corresponding internal pullup resistor which is enabled only when
the bit is set. Reset clears the keyboard interrupt enable register.
1 = PAx pin enabled as keyboard interrupt pin and corresponding internal pullup resistor enabled
0 = PAx pin not enabled as keyboard interrupt pin and corresponding internal pullup resistor
disabled
NOTE
Setting a keyboard interrupt enable bit (KBIEx) forces the corresponding
keyboard interrupt pin to be an input, overriding the data direction register.
However, the data direction register bit must be a 0 for software to read the
pin.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
91
Keyboard/External Interrupt Module (KBI)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
92
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 8
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
8.1 Introduction
The low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module monitors the voltage on the VDD pin and will set a low voltage sense
bit when VDD voltage falls to the LVI sense voltage. The LVI will force a reset when the VDD voltage falls
to the LVI trip voltage.
8.2 Features
Features of the LVI module include:
• Two levels of low-voltage condition are detected:
– Low-voltage detection
– Low-voltage reset
• User-configurable for stop mode
8.3 Functional Description
Figure 8-1 shows the structure of the LVI module. The LVI module contains a bandgap reference circuit
and two comparators. The LVI monitors VDD voltage during normal MCU operation. When enabled, the
LVI module generates a reset when VDD falls below the VLVR threshold.
VDD
STOP INSTRUCTION
LVI STOP BIT IN CONFIGURATION REGISTER
LVI PWR BIT IN CONFIGURATION REGISTER
LVIRST BIT IN CONFIGURATION REGISTER
WEAK
BATTERY
DETECTOR
VDD > VLVR = 0
DEAD
BATTERY
DETECTOR
VDD ≤ VLVR = 1
VDD
DIGITAL FILTER
RESET
LVITRIP
CGMXCLK
VDD > VLVS = 0
LOWV
VDD ≤ VLVS = 1
LOWV FLAG
Figure 8-1. LVI Module Block Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
93
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
In addition to forcing a reset condition, the LVI module has a second circuit dedicated to low-voltage
detection. When VDD falls below VLVS, the output of the low-voltage comparator asserts the LOWV flag
in the LVI status register (LVISR). In applications that require detecting low batteries, software can
monitor by polling the LOWV bit.
8.3.1 False Trip Protection
The VDD pin level is digitally filtered to reduce false dead battery detection due to power supply noise. For
the LVI module to reset due to a low-power supply, VDD must remain at or below the VLVR level for a
minimum 32–40 CGMXCLK cycles. See Table 8-1.
Table 8-1. LOWV Bit Indication
VDD
At Level:
Result
For Number of CGMXCLK Cycles:
VDD > VLVR
ANY
Filter counter remains clear
VDD < VLVR
< 32 CGMXCLK cycles
No reset, continue counting CGMXCLK
VDD < VLVR
Between 32 and 40 CGMXCLK cycles
LVI may generate a reset after 32 CGMXCLK cycles
VDD < VLVR
> 40 CGMXCLK cycles
LVI is guaranteed to generate a reset
8.3.2 Short Stop Recovery Option
The LVI has an enable time of tEN. The system stabilization time for power-on reset and long stop
recovery (both 4096 CGMXCLK cycles) gives a delay longer than the LVI enable time for these startup
scenarios. There is no period where the MCU is not protected from a low-power condition. However, when
using the short stop recovery configuration option, the 32 CGMXCLK delay must be greater than the LVI
turn on time to avoid a period in startup where the LVI is not protecting the MCU.
NOTE
The LVI is enabled automatically after reset or stop recovery, if the
LVISTOP of the CONFIG register is set. (See Chapter 3 Configuration
Register (CONFIG).)
8.4 LVI Status Register
The LVI status register flags VDD voltages below the VLVR and VLVS levels.
Address: $FE0F
Bit 7
Read: LVIOUT
Write:
Reset:
0
6
0
5
LOWV
0
0
= Unimplemented
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 8-2. LVI Status Register (LVISR)
LVIOUT — LVI Output Bit
The read-only flag becomes set when the VDD voltage falls below the VLVR voltage for 32 to 40
CGMXCLK cycles. Reset clears the LVIOUT bit.
LOWV— LVI Low Indicator Bit
This read-only flag becomes set when the LVI is detecting VDD voltage below the VLVS threshold.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
94
Freescale Semiconductor
LVI Interrupts
8.5 LVI Interrupts
The LVI module does not generate CPU interrupt requests.
8.6 Low-Power Modes
The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
8.6.1 Wait Mode
The LVI module remains active in wait mode. The LVI module can generate a reset if a VDD voltage below
the VLVR voltage is detected.
8.6.2 Stop Mode
The LVI can be enabled or disabled in stop mode by setting the LVISTOP bit in the CONFIG register. (See
Chapter 3 Configuration Register (CONFIG).)
NOTE
To minimize STOP IDD, disable the LVI in stop mode.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
95
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
96
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 9
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
9.1 Introduction
Twelve bidirectional input/output (I/O) pins form two parallel ports in the 32-pin low-profile quad flat pack
(LQFP). All I/O pins are programmable as inputs or outputs. Port A bits PTA6–PTA1 have keyboard
wakeup interrupts and internal pullup resistors.
NOTE
Connect any unused I/O pins to an appropriate logic level, either VDD or
VSS. Although the I/O ports do not require termination for proper operation,
termination reduces excess current consumption and the possibility of
electrostatic damage.
Addr.
Register Name
$0000
Port A Data Register Read:
(PTA) Write:
See page 98. Reset:
$0001
Port B Data Register Read:
(PTB) Write:
See page 100. Reset:
$0004
$0005
Data Direction Register A Read:
(DDRA) Write:
See page 98. Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTA7
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
Unaffected by reset
PTB3
Unaffected by reset
DDRA7
DDRA6
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
DDRA1
DDRA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRB3
DDRB2
DDRB1
DDRB0
0
0
0
0
Data Direction Register B Read: MCLKEN
(DDRB) Write:
See page 100. Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-1. I/O Port Register Summary
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
97
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
9.2 Port A
Port A is an 8-bit special function port that shares six of its pins with the keyboard interrupt module (KBD).
PTA6–PTA1 contain pullup resistors enabled when the port pin is enabled as a keyboard interrupt. Port
A pins are also high-current port pins with 3-mA sink capabilities.
9.2.1 Port A Data Register
The port A data register (PTA) contains a data latch for each of the eight port A pins.
Address:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Alternate Function:
$0000
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTA7
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
KBD6
KBD5
Unaffected by reset
KBD4
KBD3
KBD2
KBD1
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-2. Port A Data Register (PTA)
PTA[7:0] — Port A Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port A pin is under the control
of the corresponding bit in data direction register A. Reset has no effect on port A data.
KBD[6:1] — Keyboard Wakeup Pins
The keyboard interrupt enable bits, KBIE[6:1], in the keyboard interrupt control register enable the port
A pin as external interrupt pins and related internal pullup resistor. See Chapter 7 Keyboard/External
Interrupt Module (KBI).
NOTE
The enabling of a keyboard interrupt pin will override the corresponding
definition of the pin in the data direction register. However, the data
direction register bit must be a 0 for software to read the pin.
9.2.2 Data Direction Register A
Data direction register A (DDRA) determines whether each port A pin is an input or an output. Writing a 1
to a DDRA bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port A pin; a 0 disables the output buffer.
Address:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
$0004
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRA7
DDRA6
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
DDRA1
DDRA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 9-3. Data Direction Register A (DDRA)
DDRA[7:0] — Data Direction Register A Bits
These read/write bits control port A data direction. Reset clears DDRA[7:0], configuring all port A pins
as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port A pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port A pin configured as input
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
98
Freescale Semiconductor
Port A
NOTE
Avoid glitches on port A pins by writing to the port A data register before
changing data direction register A bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 9-4 shows the port A I/O logic.
When bit DDRAx is a 1, reading address $0000 reads the PTAx data latch. When bit DDRAx is a 0,
reading address $0000 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written,
regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 9-1 summarizes the operation of the port A pins.
READ DDRA ($0004)
VDD
INTERNAL DATA BUS
WRITE DDRA ($0004)
KBIEX
INTERNAL
PULLUP
DEVICE
DDRAx
RESET
WRITE PTA ($0000)
PTAx
PTAx
READ PTA ($0000)
Figure 9-4. Port A I/O Circuit
Table 9-1. Port A Pin Functions
KBIE(2)
Bit
DDRA
Bit
PTA
Bit
1
X
X(1)
0
0
0
1
I/O Pin
Mode
Accesses
to DDRA
Accesses to PTA
Read/Write
Read
Write
VDD(4)
DDRA[7:0]
Pin
PTA[7:0](3)
X
Input, Hi-Z(5)
DDRA[7:0]
Pin
PTA[7:0](3)
X
Output
DDRA[7:0]
PTA[7:0]
PTA[7:0]
Input,
Notes:
1. X = Don’t care
2. Keyboard interrupt enable bit (see 7.5.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register)
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
4. I/O pin pulled up to VDD by internal pullup device
5. Hi-Z = High impedance
NOTE
Setting a keyboard interrupt enable bit (KBIEx) forces the corresponding
keyboard interrupt pin to be an input, overriding the data direction register.
However, the data direction register bit must be a 0 for software to read the
pin.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
99
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
9.3 Port B
Port B is a 4-bit special function port that shares two of its pins with the timer (TIM) module and one with
the buffered internal bus clock MCLK.
9.3.1 Port B Data Register
The port B data register (PTB) contains a data latch for each of the four port B pins.
Address:
$0001
Bit 7
6
5
4
Read:
Write:
Reset:
AlternateFunction:
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTB3
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
Unaffected by reset
TCLK
TCH0
MCLK
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-5. Port B Data Register (PTB)
PTB[3:0] — Port B Data Bits
These read/write bits are software-programmable. Data direction of each port B pin is under the control
of the corresponding bit in data direction register B. Reset has no effect on port B data.
TCH0 — Timer Channel I/O Bit
The PTB2/TCH0 pin is the TIM channel 0 input capture/output compare pin. The edge/level select bits,
ELS0B:ELS0A, determine whether the PTB2/TCH0 pin is a timer channel I/O or a general-purpose I/O
pin. See Chapter 11 Timer Interface Module (TIM).
TCLK — Timer Clock Bit
The PTB3/TCLK pin is the external clock input for TIM. The prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], select
PTB3/TCLK as the TIM clock input. (See 11.8.1 TIM Status and Control Register.) When not selected
as the TIM clock, PTB3/TCLK is available for general-purpose I/O.
MCLK — Bus Clock Bit
The bus clock (MCLK) is driven out of pin PTB0/MCLK when enabled by the MCLKEN bit in port B data
direction register bit 7.
9.3.2 Data Direction Register B
Data direction register B (DDRB) determines whether each port B pin is an input or an output. Writing a 1
to a DDRB bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port B pin; a 0 disables the output buffer.
Address:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
$0005
Bit 7
MCLKEN
0
6
0
5
0
0
= Unimplemented
4
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRB3
DDRB2
DDRB1
DDRB0
0
0
0
0
Figure 9-6. Data Direction Register B (DDRB)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
100
Freescale Semiconductor
Port B
MCLKEN — MCLK Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables MCLK to be an output signal on PTB0. If MCLK is enabled, PTB0 is under
the control of MCLKEN. Reset clears this bit.
1 = MCLK output enabled
0 = MCLK output disabled
DDRB[3:0] — Data Direction Register B Bits
These read/write bits control port B data direction. Reset clears DDRB[3:0], configuring all port B pins
as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port B pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port B pin configured as input
NOTE
Avoid glitches on port B pins by writing to the port B data register before
changing data direction register B bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 9-7 shows the port B I/O logic.
READ DDRB ($0005)
INTERNAL DATA BUS
WRITE DDRB ($0005)
RESET
DDRBx
WRITE PTB ($0001)
PTBx
PTBx
READ PTB ($0001)
Figure 9-7. Port B I/O Circuit
When bit DDRBx is a 1, reading address $0001 reads the PTBx data latch. When bit DDRBx is a 0,
reading address $0001 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written,
regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 9-2 summarizes the operation of the port B pins.
Table 9-2. Port B Pin Functions
DDRB
Bit
PTB
Bit
I/O Pin
Mode
0
X
1
X
Accesses to DDRB
Accesses to PTB
Read/Write
Read
Write
Input, Hi-Z
DDRB[7]
DDRB[3:0]
Pin
PTB[3:0](1)
Output
DDRB[7]
DDRB[3:0]
PTB[3:0]
PTB[3:0]
X = Don’t care
Hi-Z = High impedance
1. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
101
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
102
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10
System Integration Module (SIM)
10.1 Introduction
This section describes the system integration module (SIM). Together with the central processor unit
(CPU), the SIM controls all MCU activities. The SIM is a system state controller that coordinates CPU and
exception timing. Figure 10-1 is a summary of the SIM input/output (I/O) registers. A block diagram of the
SIM is shown in Figure 10-2.
The SIM is responsible for:
• Bus clock generation and control for CPU and peripherals:
– Stop/wait/reset/break entry and recovery
– Internal clock control
• Master reset control, including power-on reset (POR) and computer operating properly (COP)
timeout
• Interrupt control:
– Acknowledge timing
– Arbitration control timing
– Vector address generation
• CPU enable/disable timing
Addr.
$FE00
Register Name
SIM Break Status Register Read:
(SBSR) Write:
See page 115. Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
R
R
R
R
R
R
1
SBSW
See Note
Bit 0
R
0
Note: Writing a 0 clears SBSW
$FE01
SIM Reset Status Register Read:
(SRSR) Write:
See page 115. POR:
$FE02
SIM Break Flag Control Read:
Register (SBFCR) Write:
See page 116. Reset:
POR
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
0
LVI
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
X = Indeterminate
Figure 10-1. SIM I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
103
System Integration Module (SIM)
MODULE STOP
MODULE WAIT
CPU STOP (FROM CPU)
CPU WAIT (FROM CPU)
STOP/WAIT
CONTROL
SIMOSCEN (TO ICG)
SIM
COUNTER
COP CLOCK
CGMXCLK (FROM ICG)
CGMOUT (FROM ICG)
÷2
CLOCK
CONTROL
RESET
PIN LOGIC
CLOCK GENERATORS
INTERNAL CLOCKS
LVI (FROM LVI MODULE)
POR CONTROL
MASTER
RESET
CONTROL
RESET PIN CONTROL
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER
ILLEGAL OPCODE (FROM CPU)
ILLEGAL ADDRESS (FROM ADDRESS
MAP DECODERS)
COP (FROM COP MODULE)
RESET
INTERRUPT SOURCES
INTERRUPT CONTROL
AND PRIORITY DECODE
CPU INTERFACE
Figure 10-2. SIM Block Diagram
Table 10-1 shows the internal signal names used in this section.
Table 10-1. Signal Name Conventions
Signal Name
Description
CGMXCLK
Selected clock source from internal clock generator module (ICG)
CGMOUT
Clock output from ICG module (bus clock = CGMOUT divided by two)
ICLK
Output from internal clock generator
ECLK
External clock source
IAB
Internal address bus
IDB
internal data bus
PORRST
Signal from the power-on reset module to the SIM
IRST
Internal reset signal
R/W
Read/write signal
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
104
Freescale Semiconductor
SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation
10.2 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation
The bus clock generator provides system clock signals for the CPU and peripherals on the MCU. The
system clocks are generated from an incoming clock, CGMOUT, as shown in Figure 10-3. This clock can
come from either an external oscillator or from the internal clock generator (ICG) module.
10.2.1 Bus Timing
In user mode, the internal bus frequency is either the crystal oscillator output (ECLK) divided by four or
the ICG output (ICLK) divided by four.
10.2.2 Clock Startup from POR or LVI Reset
When the power-on reset (POR) module or the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module generates a reset, the
clocks to the CPU and peripherals are inactive and held in an inactive phase until after 4096 CGMXCLK
cycles. The RST pin is driven low by the SIM during this entire period. The bus clocks start upon
completion of the timeout.
CGMXCLK
ECLK
CLOCK
SELECT
CIRCUIT
÷2
ICLK
ICG
GENERATOR
A
CGMOUT
B S*
*When S = 1,
CGMOUT = B
CS
SIM COUNTER
BUS CLOCK
GENERATORS
÷2
SIM
PTB3
MONITOR MODE
USER MODE
ICG
Figure 10-3. ICG Clock Signals
10.2.3 Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode
Upon exit from stop mode by an interrupt, break, or reset, the SIM allows CGMXCLK to clock the SIM
counter. The CPU and peripheral clocks do not become active until after the stop delay timeout. This
timeout is selectable as 4096 or 32 CGMXCLK cycles. (See 10.6.2 Stop Mode.)
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the
module is active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode.
10.3 Reset and System Initialization
The MCU has these reset sources:
• Power-on reset module (POR)
• External reset pin (RST)
• Computer operating properly module (COP)
• Low-voltage inhibit module (LVI)
• Illegal opcode
• Illegal address
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
105
System Integration Module (SIM)
All of these resets produce the vector $FFFE–FFFF ($FEFE–FEFF in monitor mode) and assert the
internal reset signal (IRST). IRST causes all registers to be returned to their default values and all
modules to be returned to their reset states.
An internal reset clears the SIM counter (see 10.4 SIM Counter), but an external reset does not. Each of
the resets sets a corresponding bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). (See 10.7 SIM Registers.)
10.3.1 External Pin Reset
Pulling the asynchronous RST pin low halts all processing. The PIN bit of the SIM reset status register
(SRSR) is set as long as RST is held low for a minimum of 67 CGMXCLK cycles, assuming that neither
the POR nor the LVI was the source of the reset.
Figure 10-4 shows the relative timing of an external reset recovery.
PULLED LOW EXTERNAL
RST
PULLED HIGH EXTERNAL
CGMOUT
IAB
VECT H
PC
VECT L
Figure 10-4. External Reset Recovery Timing
10.3.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources
All internal reset sources actively pull the RST pin low for 32 CGMXCLK cycles to allow resetting of
external peripherals. The internal reset signal IRST continues to be asserted for an additional 32 cycles.
(See Figure 10-5.) An internal reset can be caused by an illegal address, illegal opcode, COP timeout,
LVI, or POR. (See Figure 10-6.) Note that for LVI or POR resets, the SIM cycles through 4096 CGMXCLK
cycles during which the SIM forces the RST pin low. The internal reset signal then follows the sequence
from the falling edge of RST shown in Figure 10-5.
The COP reset is asynchronous to the bus clock.
The active reset feature allows the part to issue a reset to peripherals and other chips within a system
built around the MCU.
IRST
RST
RST PULLED LOW BY MCU
32 CYCLES
32 CYCLES
CGMXCLK
IAB
VECTOR HIGH
Figure 10-5. Internal Reset Timing
ILLEGAL ADDRESS RST
ILLEGAL OPCODE RST
COPRST
LVI
POR
INTERNAL RESET
Figure 10-6. Sources of Internal Reset
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
106
Freescale Semiconductor
Reset and System Initialization
10.3.2.1 Power-On Reset
When power is first applied to the MCU, the power-on reset module (POR) generates a pulse to indicate
that power-on has occurred. The external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out
4096 CGMXCLK cycles. Another 64 CGMXCLK cycles later, the CPU and memories are released from
reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur.
At power-on, these events occur:
• A POR pulse is generated.
• The internal reset signal is asserted.
• The SIM enables CGMOUT.
• Internal clocks to the CPU and modules are held inactive for 4096 CGMXCLK cycles to allow
stabilization of the oscillator.
• The RST pin is driven low during the oscillator stabilization time.
• The POR bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set and all other bits in the register are
cleared.
OSC1
PORRST
4096
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
CGMXCLK
CGMOUT
RST
$FFFE
IAB
$FFFF
Figure 10-7. POR Recovery
10.3.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset
The overflow of the COP counter causes an internal reset and sets the COP bit in the SIM reset status
register (SRSR) if the COPD bit in the CONFIG register is at 0. (See Chapter 4 Computer Operating
Properly Module (COP).)
10.3.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset
The SIM decodes signals from the CPU to detect illegal instructions. An illegal instruction sets the ILOP
bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and causes a reset.
If the stop enable bit, STOP, in the configuration register (CONFIG) is 0, the SIM treats the STOP
instruction as an illegal opcode and causes an illegal opcode reset.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
107
System Integration Module (SIM)
10.3.2.4 Illegal Address Reset
An opcode fetch from an unmapped address generates an illegal address reset. The SIM verifies that the
CPU is fetching an opcode prior to asserting the ILAD bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and
resetting the MCU. A data fetch from an unmapped address does not generate a reset.
10.3.2.5 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset
The low-voltage inhibit module (LVI) asserts its output to the SIM when the VDD voltage falls to the VLVR
voltage. The LVI bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set and a chip reset is asserted if the
LVIPWRD and LVIRSTD bits in the CONFIG register are at 0. The RST pin will be held low until the SIM
counts 4096 CGMXCLK cycles after VDD rises above VLVR+ HLVR. Another 64 CGMXCLK cycles later,
the CPU is released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur. (See Chapter 8 Low-Voltage
Inhibit (LVI).)
10.4 SIM Counter
The SIM counter is used by the power-on reset module (POR) and in stop mode recovery to allow the
oscillator time to stabilize before enabling the internal bus (IBUS) clocks. The SIM counter also serves as
a prescaler for the computer operating properly module (COP). The SIM counter overflow supplies the
clock for the COP module. The SIM counter is 12 bits long and is clocked by the falling edge of
CGMXCLK.
10.4.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset
The power-on reset module (POR) detects power applied to the MCU. At power-on, the POR circuit
asserts the signal PORRST. Once the SIM is initialized, it enables the internal clock generation module
(ICG) to drive the bus clock state machine.
10.4.2 SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery
The SIM counter also is used for stop mode recovery. The STOP instruction clears the SIM counter. After
an interrupt, break, or reset, the SIM senses the state of the short stop recovery bit, SSREC, in the
CONFIG register. If the SSREC bit is a 1, then the stop recovery is reduced from the normal delay of 4096
CGMXCLK cycles down to 32 CGMXCLK cycles. This is ideal for applications using canned oscillators
that do not require long startup times from stop mode. External crystal applications should use the full
stop recovery time, that is, with SSREC cleared.
10.4.3 SIM Counter and Reset States
External reset has no effect on the SIM counter. See 10.6.2 Stop Mode for details. The SIM counter is
free-running after all reset states. See 10.3.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources for counter control and
internal reset recovery sequences.
10.5 Program Exception Control
Normal, sequential program execution can be changed in three different ways:
1. Interrupts:
a. Maskable hardware CPU interrupts
b. Non-maskable software interrupt instruction (SWI)
2. Reset
3. Break interrupts
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
108
Freescale Semiconductor
Program Exception Control
10.5.1 Interrupts
At the beginning of an interrupt, the CPU saves the CPU register contents on the stack and sets the
interrupt mask (I bit) to prevent additional interrupts. At the end of an interrupt, the RTI instruction recovers
the CPU register contents from the stack so that normal processing can resume. Figure 10-8 shows
interrupt entry timing. Figure 10-9 shows interrupt recovery timing.
Interrupts are latched, and arbitration is performed in the SIM at the start of interrupt processing. The
arbitration result is a constant that the CPU uses to determine which vector to fetch. Once an interrupt is
latched by the SIM, no other interrupt can take precedence, regardless of priority, until the latched
interrupt is serviced (or the I bit is cleared). (See Figure 10-10.)
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I BIT
IAB
IDB
DUMMY
SP
DUMMY
SP – 1
PC – 1[7:0]
SP – 2
PC–1[15:8]
SP – 3
X
SP – 4
A
VECT H
CCR
VECT L
V DATA H
START ADDR
V DATA L
OPCODE
R/W
Figure 10-8. Interrupt Entry
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I BIT
IAB
IDB
SP – 4
SP – 3
CCR
SP – 2
A
SP – 1
X
SP
PC – 1 [15:8]
PC
PC–1[7:0]
PC + 1
OPCODE
OPERAND
R/W
Figure 10-9. Interrupt Recovery
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
109
System Integration Module (SIM)
FROM RESET
YES
BREAK
INTERRUPT?
I BIT
SET?
NO
YES
I BIT SET?
NO
IRQ
INTERRUPT?
YES
NO
STACK CPU REGISTERS
SET I BIT
LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR
AS MANY INTERRUPTS
AS EXIST ON CHIP
FETCH NEXT
INSTRUCTION
SWI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
NO
RTI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS
NO
EXECUTE INSTRUCTION
Figure 10-10. Interrupt Processing
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
110
Freescale Semiconductor
Program Exception Control
10.5.1.1 Hardware Interrupts
A hardware interrupt does not stop the current instruction. Processing of a hardware interrupt begins after
completion of the current instruction. When the current instruction is complete, the SIM checks all pending
hardware interrupts. If interrupts are not masked (I bit clear in the condition code register), and if the
corresponding interrupt enable bit is set, the SIM proceeds with interrupt processing; otherwise, the next
instruction is fetched and executed.
If more than one interrupt is pending at the end of an instruction execution, the highest priority interrupt is
serviced first. Figure 10-11 demonstrates what happens when two interrupts are pending. If an interrupt
is pending upon exit from the original interrupt service routine, the pending interrupt is serviced before the
LDA instruction is executed.
The LDA opcode is prefetched by both the INT1 and INT2 RTI instructions. However, in the case of the
INT1 RTI prefetch, this is a redundant operation.
NOTE
To maintain compatibility with the M68HC05, M6805, and M146805
Families, the H register is not pushed on the stack during interrupt entry. If
the interrupt service routine modifies the H register or uses the indexed
addressing mode, software should save the H register and then restore it
prior to exiting the routine.
CLI
BACKGROUND
ROUTINE
LDA #$FF
INT1
PSHH
INT1 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
INT2
PSHH
INT2 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
Figure 10-11. Interrupt Recognition Example
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
111
System Integration Module (SIM)
10.5.1.2 SWI Instruction
The SWI instruction is a non-maskable instruction that causes an interrupt regardless of the state of the
interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register.
NOTE
A software interrupt pushes PC onto the stack. A software interrupt does
not push PC – 1, as a hardware interrupt does.
10.5.2 Reset
All reset sources always have higher priority than interrupts and cannot be arbitrated.
10.5.3 Break Interrupts
The break module can stop normal program flow at a software-programmable break point by asserting its
break interrupt output. (See Chapter 13 Development Support.) The SIM puts the CPU into the break
state by forcing it to the SWI vector location. Refer to the break interrupt subsection of each module to
see how each module is affected by the break state.
10.5.4 Status Flag Protection in Break Mode
The SIM controls whether status flags contained in other modules can be cleared during break mode. The
user can select whether flags are protected from being cleared by properly initializing the break clear flag
enable bit (BCFE) in the break flag control register (BFCR).
Protecting flags in break mode ensures that set flags will not be cleared while in break mode. This
protection allows registers to be freely read and written during break mode without losing status flag
information.
Setting the BCFE bit enables the clearing mechanisms. Once cleared in break mode, a flag remains
cleared even when break mode is exited. Status flags with a 2-step clearing mechanism — for example,
a read of one register followed by the read or write of another — are protected, even when the first step
is accomplished prior to entering break mode. Upon leaving break mode, execution of the second step
will clear the flag as normal.
10.6 Low-Power Modes
Executing the WAIT or STOP instruction puts the MCU in a low power- consumption mode for standby
situations. The SIM holds the CPU in a non-clocked state. The operation of each of these modes is
described here. Both STOP and WAIT clear the interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register, allowing
interrupts to occur.
10.6.1 Wait Mode
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive while one set of peripheral clocks continues to run.
Figure 10-12 shows the timing for wait mode entry.
A module that is active during wait mode can wake up the CPU with an interrupt if the interrupt is enabled.
Stacking for the interrupt begins one cycle after the WAIT instruction during which the interrupt occurred.
Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the module is active or inactive in wait mode.
Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
112
Freescale Semiconductor
Low-Power Modes
Wait mode can also be exited by a reset or break. A break interrupt during wait mode sets the SIM break
stop/wait bit, SBSW, in the SIM break status register (SBSR). If the COP disable bit, COPD, in the mask
option register is 0, then the computer operating properly module (COP) is enabled and remains active in
wait mode.
IAB
WAIT ADDR + 1
WAIT ADDR
IDB
PREVIOUS DATA
SAME
SAME
NEXT OPCODE
SAME
SAME
R/W
Note: Previous data can be operand data or the WAIT opcode, depending on the last instruction.
Figure 10-12. Wait Mode Entry Timing
Figure 10-13 and Figure 10-14 show the timing for WAIT recovery.
IAB
$6E0B
IDB
$A6
$A6
$6E0C
$A6
$01
$00FF
$00FE
$0B
$00FD
$00FC
$6E
EXITSTOPWAIT
Note: EXITSTOPWAIT = RST pin or CPU interrupt or break interrupt
Figure 10-13. Wait Recovery from Interrupt or Break
32
CYCLES
IAB
IDB
$6E0B
$A6
$A6
32
CYCLES
RSTVCTH
RST VCTL
$A6
RST
CGMXCLK
Figure 10-14. Wait Recovery from Internal Reset
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
113
System Integration Module (SIM)
10.6.2 Stop Mode
In stop mode, the SIM counter is reset and the system clocks are disabled. An interrupt request from a
module can cause an exit from stop mode. Stacking for interrupts begins after the selected stop recovery
time has elapsed. Reset or break also causes an exit from stop mode.
The SIM disables the clock generator module outputs (CGMOUT and CGMXCLK) in stop mode, stopping
the CPU and peripherals. Stop recovery time is selectable using the SSREC bit in the CONFIG register.
If SSREC is set, stop recovery is reduced from the normal delay of 4096 CGMXCLK cycles down to 32.
This is ideal for applications using canned oscillators that do not require long startup times from stop
mode.
NOTE
External crystal applications should use the full stop recovery time by
clearing the SSREC bit.
A break interrupt during stop mode sets the SIM break stop/wait bit (SBSW) in the SIM break status
register (SBSR).
The SIM counter is held in reset from the execution of the STOP instruction until the beginning of stop
recovery. It is then used to time the recovery period. Figure 10-15 shows stop mode entry timing.
CPUSTOP
IAB
STOP ADDR
IDB
STOP ADDR + 1
PREVIOUS DATA
SAME
NEXT OPCODE
SAME
SAME
SAME
R/W
Note: Previous data can be operand data or the STOP opcode, depending on the last instruction.
Figure 10-15. Stop Mode Entry Timing
STOP RECOVERY PERIOD
CGMXCLK
INT/BREAK
IAB
STOP +1
STOP + 2
STOP + 2
SP
SP – 1
SP – 2
SP – 3
Figure 10-16. Stop Mode Recovery from Interrupt or Break
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
114
Freescale Semiconductor
SIM Registers
10.7 SIM Registers
The SIM has three memory mapped registers:
• SIM break status register, SBSR
• SIM reset status register, SRSR
• SIM break flag control register, SBFCR
10.7.1 SIM Break Status Register
The SIM break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break caused an exit from stop or
wait mode.
Address:
Read:
Write:
$FE00
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
R
R
R
R
R
R
1
SBSW
See Note
Reset:
Bit 0
R
0
R
= Reserved
Note: Writing a 0 clears SBSW.
Figure 10-17. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR)
SBSW — SIM Break Stop/Wait Bit
SBSW can be read within the break state SWI routine. The user can modify the return address on the
stack by subtracting one from it. Writing 0 to the SBSW bit clears it.
1 = Wait mode was exited by break interrupt.
0 = Wait mode was not exited by break interrupt.
10.7.2 SIM Reset Status Register
This register contains six flags that show the source of the last reset. The status register will clear
automatically after reading it. A power-on reset sets the POR bit.
Address:
Read:
$FE01
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
POR
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
0
LVI
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Write:
POR:
= Unimplemented
X = Indeterminate
Figure 10-18. SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR)
POR — Power-On Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by POR circuit
0 = Read of SRSR
PIN — External Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by external reset pin (RST)
0 = Read of SRSR
COP — Computer Operating Properly Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by COP counter
0 = Read of SRSR
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
115
System Integration Module (SIM)
ILOP — Illegal Opcode Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by an illegal opcode
0 = Read of SRSR
ILAD — Illegal Address Reset Bit (opcode fetches only)
1 = Last reset caused by an opcode fetch from an illegal address
0 = Read of SRSR
LVI — Low-Voltage Inhibit Reset Bit
1 = Last reset was caused by the LVI circuit
0 = Read of SRSR
10.7.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register
The SIM break control register contains a bit that enables software to clear status bits while the MCU is
in a break state.
Address:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
$FE02
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 10-19. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR)
BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing status registers while the MCU is
in a break state. To clear status bits during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set.
1 = Status bits clearable during break
0 = Status bits not clearable during break
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
116
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
11.1 Introduction
This section describes the timer interface module (TIM). The TIM is a 2-channel timer:
• The first channel, channel 0, provides a timing reference with input capture, output compare, and
pulse-width-modulation (PWM) functions.
• The second channel, channel 1, provides reduced functionality as it doesn’t have an external pin.
Figure 11-2 is a block diagram of the TIM.
11.2 Features
Features of the TIM include:
• One input capture/output compare channel:
– Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger
– Set, clear, or toggle output compare action
• Buffered and unbuffered PWM signal generation
• Programmable TIM clock input:
– 7-frequency internal bus clock prescaler selection
– External TIM clock input (bus frequency ÷ 2 maximum)
• Free-running or modulo up-count operation
• Toggle any channel pin on overflow
• TIM counter stop and reset bits
11.3 Pin Name Conventions
The TIM module shares pins with two port B input/output (I/O) port pins. The full names of the TIM I/O
pins and generic pin names are listed in Table 11-1.
Table 11-1. Pin Name Conventions
TIM Generic Pin Names
TCH0
TCLK
Full TIM Pin Names
PTB2/TCH0
PTB3/TCLK
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
117
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
INTERNAL BUS
M68HC08 CPU
CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 32 BYTES
PTA7(2)
PTA6/KBD6(2) (3)
PTA5/KBD5(2) (3)
SECURITY
MODULE
PTA
ARITHMETIC/LOGIC
UNIT (ALU)
DDRA
CPU
REGISTERS
COMPUTER OPERATING
PROPERLY MODULE
PTB
LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT
MODULE
DDRB
MONITOR ROM — 768 BYTES
PTA3/KBD3(2) (3)
PTA2/KBD2(2) (3)
PTA1/KBD1(2) (3)
PTA0(2)
USER FLASH — 2031 BYTES
USER RAM — 128 BYTES
PTA4/KBD4(2) (3)
2-CHANNEL TIMER
MODULE
PTB3/TCLK
PTB2/TCH0
PTB1
PTB0/MCLK
USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 14 BYTES
OSC2
OSC1
SOFTWARE SELECTABLE
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
MODULE
VCC
MODE
RST(1)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
IRQ(1)
KEYBOARD/INTERRUPT
MODULE
ENABLE
DATA
BAND
UHF
TRANSMITTER
RFOUT
GNDRF
REXT
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
XTAL1
XTAL0
DATACLK
VDD
CFSK
POWER
VSS
1. Pin contains integrated pullup resistor
2. High current sink pin
3. Pin contains software selectable pullup resistor
Figure 11-1. Block Diagram Highlighting TIM Block and Pins
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
118
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
11.4 Functional Description
Figure 11-2 shows the structure of the TIM. The central component of the TIM is the 16-bit TIM counter
that can operate as a free-running counter or a modulo up-counter. The TIM counter provides the timing
reference for the input capture and output compare functions. The TIM counter modulo registers, TMODH
and TMODL, control the modulo value of the TIM counter. Software can read the TIM counter value at
any time without affecting the counting sequence.
TIM channel 0 is programmable independently as input capture or output compare. TIM channel 1 is
programmable only as output compare. The output compare is detected only through an interrupt.
WARNING
TIM channel 1 should not be configured as an input capture because
this would result in a floating input that would cause a higher IDD.
Refer to Figure 11-3 for a summary of the TIM I/O registers.
PTB3/TCLK
PRESCALER SELECT
INTERNAL
BUS CLOCK
PRESCALER
TSTOP
PS2
TRST
PS1
PS0
16-BIT COUNTER
TOF
TOIE
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TMODH:TMODL
TOV0
INTERNAL BUS
CHANNEL 0
ELS0B
ELS0A
CH0MAX
PORT
LOGIC
PTB2/TCH0
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH0H:TCH0L
CH0F
16-BIT LATCH
MS0A
CH0IE
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
MS0B
TOV1
CHANNEL 1
ELS1B
ELS1A
CH1MAX
PORT
LOGIC
N/C*
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH1H:TCH1L
CH1F
16-BIT LATCH
MS1A
CH1IE
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
*This pin is not available on the MC68HC908RF2.
Figure 11-2. TIM Block Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
119
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
TOIE
TSTOP
4
3
0
0
2
1
Bit 0
PS2
PS1
PS0
Timer Status and Control Read:
Register (TSC) Write:
See page 126. Reset:
TOF
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
$0021
Timer Counter Register High Read:
(TCNTH) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
$0022
Timer Counter Register Low Read:
(TCNTL) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
$0020
$0023
Timer Counter Modulo Regis- Read:
ter High (TMODH) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
Timer Counter Modulo Regis- Read:
$0024
ter Low (TMODL) Write:
See page 128. Reset:
$0025
Timer Channel 0 Status Read:
and Control Register (TSC0) Write:
See page 129. Reset:
$0026
Timer Channel 0 Register Read:
High (TCH0H) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
$0027
$0028
Timer Channel 0 Register Read:
Low (TCH0L) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
Timer Channel 1 Status Read:
and Control Register (TSC1) Write:
See page 129. Reset:
$0029
Timer Channel 1 Register Read:
High (TCH1H)) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
$002A
Timer Channel 1 Register Read:
Low (TCH1L)) Write:
See page 132. Reset:
0
CH0F
0
TRST
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
CH1F
0
0
CH1IE
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-3. TIM I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
120
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
11.4.1 TIM Counter Prescaler
The TIM clock source can be one of the seven prescaler outputs or the TIM clock pin, TCLK. The
prescaler generates seven clock rates from the internal bus clock. The prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in
the TIM status and control register select the TIM clock source.
11.4.2 Input Capture
With the input capture function, the TIM can capture the time at which an external event occurs. When an
active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel, the TIM latches the contents of the TIM counter
into the TIM channel registers, TCHxH and TCHxL. The polarity of the active edge is programmable. Input
captures can generate TIM CPU interrupt requests.
NOTE
TIM channel 1 should not be configured in this mode.
11.4.3 Output Compare
With the output compare function, the TIM can generate a periodic pulse with a programmable polarity,
duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the value in the registers of an output compare
channel, the TIM channel 0 can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. Output compares can generate
TIM CPU interrupt requests for both TIM channel 0 and TIM channel 1.
NOTE
TIM channel 1 does not have an external pin associated with it.
11.4.4 Unbuffered Output Compare
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare pulses as described in 11.4.3
Output Compare. The pulses are unbuffered because changing the output compare value requires writing
the new value over the old value currently in the TIM channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change an output compare value could cause
incorrect operation for up to two counter overflow periods. For example, writing a new value before the
counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during
that counter overflow period. Also, using a TIM overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output
compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIM may pass the new value before it is written.
Use these methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the output compare value on channel x:
• When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output compare interrupts and write the new
value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of
the current output compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the counter overflow
period to write the new value.
• When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIM overflow interrupts and write the new
value in the TIM overflow interrupt routine. The TIM overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the
current counter overflow period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at
the end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the same counter
overflow period.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
121
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
11.4.5 Buffered Output Compare
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare channel whose output appears on the
PTB2/TCH0 pin. The TIM channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1.
The output compare value in the TIM channel 0 registers initially controls the output on the TCH0 pin.
Writing to the TIM channel 1 registers enables the TIM channel 1 registers to synchronously control the
output after the TIM overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1) that
control the output are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the buffered output compare
function, and TIM channel 1 status and control register (TSC1) is unused.
NOTE
In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare
values to the currently active channel registers. User software should track
the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active
channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating
unbuffered output compares.
11.4.6 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM)
By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel, the TIM can generate a
pulse-width modulation (PWM) signal. The value in the TIM counter modulo registers determines the
period of the PWM signal. The channel pin toggles when the counter reaches the value in the TIM counter
modulo registers. The time between overflows is the period of the PWM signal.
As Figure 11-4 shows, the output compare value in the TIM channel registers determines the pulse width
of the PWM signal. The time between overflow and output compare is the pulse width. Program the TIM
to clear channel 0 pin on output compare if the state of the PWM pulse is logic 1. Program the TIM to set
the pin if the state of the PWM pulse is logic 0.
The value in the TIM counter modulo registers and the selected prescaler output determines the
frequency of the PWM output. The frequency of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing
$00FF (255) to the TIM counter modulo registers produces a PWM period of 256 times the internal bus
clock period if the prescaler select value is $000. See 11.8.1 TIM Status and Control Register.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PULSE
WIDTH
PTB2/TCH0
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
Figure 11-4. PWM Period and Pulse Width
The value in the TIM channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM output. The pulse width of
an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $0080 (128) to the TIM channel registers
produces a duty cycle of 128/256 or 50 percent.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
122
Freescale Semiconductor
Functional Description
11.4.7 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as described in 11.4.6 Pulse-Width
Modulation (PWM). The pulses are unbuffered because changing the pulse width requires writing the new
pulse width value over the old value currently in the TIM channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change a pulse width value could cause incorrect
operation for up to two PWM periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the
old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that PWM period.
Also, using a TIM overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller pulse width value may cause the
compare to be missed. The TIM may pass the new value before it is written.
Use these methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the PWM pulse width on channel:
• When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel output compare interrupts and write the
new value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end
of the current pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the PWM period to write the new
value.
• When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIM overflow interrupts and write the new value in
the TIM overflow interrupt routine. The TIM overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current PWM
period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse)
could cause two output compares to occur in the same PWM period.
NOTE
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on
output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0 percent
duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct
in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare also can
cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse
width to a new, much larger value.
11.4.8 Buffered PWM Signal Generation
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose output appears on the TCH0 pin.
The TIM channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1.
The TIM channel 0 registers initially control the pulse width on the TCH0 pin. Writing to the TIM channel 1
registers enables the TIM channel 1 registers to synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning
of the next PWM period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1) that control the
pulse width are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIM
channel 1 status and control register (TSC1) is unused.
NOTE
In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values to
the currently active channel registers. User software should track the
currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active
channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating
unbuffered PWM signals.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
123
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
11.4.9 PWM Initialization
To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered PWM signals, use this initialization
procedure:
1. In the TIM status and control register (TSC):
a. Stop the TIM counter by setting the TIM stop bit, TSTOP.
b. Reset the TIM counter and prescaler by setting the TIM reset bit, TRST.
2. In the TIM counter modulo registers (TMODH and TMODL), write the value for the required PWM
period.
3. In the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH and TCHxL), write the value for the required pulse width.
4. In TIM channel x status and control register (TSCx):
a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or 1:0 (for buffered output compare
or PWM signals) to the mode select bits, MSxB and MSxA. See Table 11-3.
b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx.
c. Write 1:0 (to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (to set output on compare) to the edge/level
select bits, ELSxB and ELSxA. The output action on compare must force the output to the
complement of the pulse width level. See Table 11-3.
NOTE
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on
output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0 percent
duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct
in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare can also
cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse
width to a new, much larger value.
5. In the TIM status control register (TSC), clear the TIM stop bit, TSTOP.
Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered PWM operation. The TIM
channel 0 registers (TCH0H and TCH0L) initially control the buffered PWM output. TIM status control
register 0 (TSCR0) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked channels.
Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on TIM overflows. Subsequent output
compares try to force the output to a state it is already in and have no effect. The result is a 0 percent duty
cycle output.
Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the TOVx bit generates a 100
percent duty cycle output. See 11.8.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers.
11.5 Interrupts
These TIM sources can generate interrupt requests:
• TIM overflow flag (TOF) — The timer overflow flag (TOF) bit is set when the TIM counter reaches
the modulo value programmed in the TIM counter modulo registers. The TIM overflow interrupt
enable bit, TOIE, enables TIM overflow interrupt requests. TOF and TOIE are in the TIM status and
control registers.
• TIM channel flag (CH0F) — The CH0F bit is set when an input capture or output compare occurs
on channel. Channel TIM CPU interrupt requests are controlled by the channel interrupt enable bit,
CH1IE.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
124
Freescale Semiconductor
TIM During Break Interrupts
11.5.1 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
11.5.2 Wait Mode
The TIM remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode, the TIM registers are not
accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the TIM can bring the MCU out of wait
mode.
If TIM functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by stopping the TIM before
executing the WAIT instruction.
11.5.3 Stop Mode
The TIM is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The STOP instruction does not affect
register conditions or the state of the TIM counter. TIM operation resumes when the MCU exits stop mode
after an external interrupt.
11.6 TIM During Break Interrupts
A break interrupt stops the TIM counter.
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in other modules can be cleared during
the break state. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear
status bits during the break state. See 10.7.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register.
To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is
cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect status bits during the break state, write a 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at 0 (its default state),
software can read and write I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some status
bits have a 2-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does the first step on such a bit before the
break, the bit cannot change during the break state as long as BCFE is at 0. After the break, doing the
second step clears the status bit.
11.7 I/O Signals
Port B shares two of its pins with the TIM. TCLK can be used as an external clock input to the TIM
prescaler and the TIM channel 0 I/O pin PTB2/TCH0.
11.7.1 TIM Clock Pin (TCLK)
TCLK is an external clock input that can be the clock source for the TIM counter instead of the prescaled
internal bus clock. Select the TCLK input by writing 1s to the three prescaler select bits, PS2–PS0. See
11.8.1 TIM Status and Control Register. The minimum TCLK pulse width, TCLKLMIN or TCLKHMIN, is:
1
+ tsu
bus frequency
The maximum TCLK frequency is:
bus frequency ÷ 2
Refer to 14.9 Control Timing.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
125
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
TCLK is available as a general-purpose I/O pin when not used as the TIM clock input. When the TCLK
pin is the TIM clock input, it is an input regardless of the state of the DDRB3 bit in data direction register B.
11.7.2 TIM Channel I/O Pins (TCH0)
The channel I/O pins are programmable independently as an input capture pin or an output compare pin.
TCH0 can be configured as buffered output compare or buffered PWM pins.
11.8 I/O Registers
These I/O registers control and monitor operation of the TIM:
• TIM status and control register, TSC
• TIM control registers, TCNTH and TCNTL
• TIM counter modulo registers, TMODH and TMODL
• TIM channel status and control registers, TSC0 and TSC1
• TIM channel registers, TCH0H, TCH0L, TCH1H, and TCH1L
11.8.1 TIM Status and Control Register
The TIM status and control register (TSC):
• Enables TIM overflow interrupts
• Flags TIM overflows
• Stops the TIM counter
• Resets the TIM counter
• Prescales the TIM counter clock
Address:
$0020
Bit 7
Read:
TOF
Write:
0
Reset:
0
6
5
TOIE
TSTOP
0
1
4
3
0
0
TRST
0
0
2
1
Bit 0
PS2
PS1
PS0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-5. TIM Status and Control Register
TOF — TIM Overflow Flag Bit
This read/write flag is set when the TIM counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIM
counter modulo registers. Clear TOF by reading the TIM status and control register when TOF is set
and then writing a 0 to TOF. If another TIM overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete,
then writing 0 to TOF has no effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost due to
inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a 1 to TOF has no effect.
1 = TIM counter has reached modulo value.
0 = TIM counter has not reached modulo value.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
126
Freescale Semiconductor
I/O Registers
TOIE — TIM Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIM overflow interrupts when the TOF bit becomes set. Reset clears the
TOIE bit.
1 = TIM overflow interrupts enabled
0 = TIM overflow interrupts disabled
TSTOP — TIM Stop Bit
This read/write bit stops the TIM counter. Counting resumes when TSTOP is cleared. Reset sets the
TSTOP bit, stopping the TIM counter until software clears the TSTOP bit.
1 = TIM counter stopped
0 = TIM counter active
NOTE
Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIM is required
to exit wait mode.
TRST — TIM Reset Bit
Setting this write-only bit resets the TIM counter and the TIM prescaler. Setting TRST has no effect on
any other registers. Counting resumes from $0000. TRST is cleared automatically after the TIM
counter is reset and always reads as 0. Reset clears the TRST bit.
1 = Prescaler and TIM counter cleared
0 = No effect
NOTE
Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIM counter at
a value of $0000.
PS2–PS0 — Prescaler Select Bits
These read/write bits select either the TCLK pin or one of the seven prescaler outputs as the input to
the TIM counter as Table 11-2 shows. Reset clears the PS2–PS0 bits.
Table 11-2. Prescaler Selection
PS2–PS0
TIM Clock Source
000
Internal bus clock ÷1
001
Internal bus clock ÷ 2
010
Internal bus clock ÷ 4
011
Internal bus clock ÷ 8
100
Internal bus clock ÷ 16
101
Internal bus clock ÷ 32
110
Internal bus clock ÷ 64
111
TCLK
11.8.2 TIM Counter Registers
The two read-only TIM counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value in the TIM counter.
Reading the high byte (TCNTH) latches the contents of the low byte (TCNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent
reads of TCNTH do not affect the latched TCNTL value until TCNTL is read. Reset clears the TIM counter
registers. Setting the TIM reset bit (TRST) also clears the TIM counter registers
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
127
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
NOTE
If you read TCNTH during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TCNTL by
reading TCNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise, TCNTL
retains the value latched during the break.
Register Name and Address: TCNTH—$0021
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Register Name and Address: TCNTL—$0022
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-6. TIM Counter Registers (TCNTH and TCNTL)
11.8.3 TIM Counter Modulo Registers
The read/write TIM modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TIM counter. When the TIM counter
reaches the modulo value, the overflow flag (TOF) becomes set, and the TIM counter resumes counting
from $0000 at the next timer clock. Writing to the high byte (TMODH) inhibits the TOF bit and overflow
interrupts until the low byte (TMODL) is written. Reset sets the TIM counter modulo registers.
Register Name and Address: TMODH—$0023
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Register Name and Address: TMODL—$0024
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 11-7. TIM Counter Modulo Registers (TMODH and TMODL)
NOTE
Reset the TIM counter before writing to the TIM counter modulo registers.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
128
Freescale Semiconductor
I/O Registers
11.8.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers
Each of the TIM channel status and control registers (TSC0 and TSC1):
•
Flags input captures and output compares
•
Enables input capture and output compare interrupts
•
Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation
•
Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare
•
Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input capture trigger
•
Selects output toggling on TIM overflow
•
Selects 0 percent and 100 percent PWM duty cycle
•
Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
Register Name and Address: TSC0—$0025
Bit 7
Read:
CH0F
Write:
0
Reset:
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
0
0
0
0
0
Register Name and Address: TSC1—$0028
Bit 7
Read:
CH1F
Write:
0
Reset:
0
6
CH1IE
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-8. TIM Channel Status and Control Registers (TSC0 and TSC1)
CHxF — Channel x Flag Bit
When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set when an active edge occurs on
the channel x pin. When channel x is an output compare channel, CHxF is set when the value in the
TIM counter registers matches the value in the TIM channel x registers.
When TIM CPU interrupt requests are enabled (CHxIE = 1), clear CHxF by reading TIM channel x
status and control register with CHxF set and then writing a 0 to CHxF. If another interrupt request
occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing 0 to CHxF has no effect. Therefore, an
interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF.
Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a 1 to CHxF has no effect.
1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x
0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x
CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIM CPU interrupts on channel x.
Reset clears the CHxIE bit.
1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
129
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MSxB — Mode Select Bit B
This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation. MSxB exists only in the TIM
channel 0 and TIM channel 1 status and control registers. Setting MS0B disables the TIM channel 1
status and control register. Reset clears the MSxB bit.
1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled
0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled
MSxA — Mode Select Bit A
When ELSxB:A ≠ 00, this read/write bit selects either input capture operation or unbuffered output
compare/PWM operation. See Table 11-3.
1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
0 = Input capture operation
When ELSxB:A = 00, this read/write bit selects the initial output level of the TCH0 pin. See Table 11-3.
Reset clears the MSxA bit.
1 = Initial output level low
0 = Initial output level high
NOTE
Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit, set
the TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIM status and control register (TSC).
Table 11-3. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection
MSxB
MSxA
ELSxB
ELSxA
Mode
X
0
0
0
X
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
Capture on rising or falling edge
0
1
0
0
Software compare only
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
X
0
1
1
X
1
0
1
X
1
1
Output preset
Configuration
Pin under port control; initial output level high
Pin under port control; initial output level low
Capture on rising edge only
Input capture
Output compare
or PWM
Capture on falling edge only
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
Buffered output
compare or
buffered PWM
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits
When channel 0 is an input capture channel, these read/write bits control the active edge-sensing logic
on channel x. When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA control the channel
x output behavior when an output compare occurs.
When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected to port B, and pin PTB0/TCH0 is
available as a general-purpose I/O pin. Table 11-3 shows how ELSxB and ELSxA work. Reset clears
the ELSxB and ELSxA bits.
NOTE
TIM channel 1 does not have an external pin associated with it.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
130
Freescale Semiconductor
I/O Registers
NOTE
Before enabling a TIM channel register for input capture operation, make
sure that the PTB/TCH0 pin is stable for at least two bus clocks.
TOVx — Toggle On Overflow Bit
When channel 0 is an output compare channel, this read/write bit controls the behavior of the channel
0 output when the TIM counter overflows. When channel 0 is an input capture channel, TOV0 has no
effect. Reset clears the TOV0 bit.
1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIM counter overflow.
0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIM counter overflow.
NOTE
The state of TOV1 has no effect since there is no pin.
When TOVx is set, a TIM counter overflow takes precedence over a
channel x output compare if both occur at the same time.
Channel 1 should not be configured in input capture mode.
WARNING
The user must configure TIM channel 1 in a mode other than input
capture. It is recommended that this procedure be part of the
initialization of the system after reset.
CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit
When the TOVx bit is at 1 and clear output on compare is selected, setting the CHxMAX bit forces the
duty cycle of buffered and unbuffered PWM signals to 100 percent. As Figure 11-9 shows, the
CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it is set or cleared. The output stays at 100 percent duty
cycle level until the cycle after CHxMAX is cleared.
NOTE
The PWM 0 percent duty cycle is defined as output low all of the time. To
generate the 0 percent duty cycle, select clear output on compare and then
clear the TOVx bit (CHxMAX = 0). The PWM 100 percent duty cycle is
defined as output high all of the time. To generate the 100 percent duty
cycle, use the CHxMAX bit in the TSCx register.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PTBx/TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
CHxMAX
Figure 11-9. CHxMAX Latency
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
131
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
11.8.5 TIM Channel Registers
These read/write registers contain the captured TIM counter value of the input capture function or the
output compare value of the output compare function. The state of the TIM channel registers after reset
is unknown.
In input capture mode (MSxB:MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH)
inhibits input captures until the low byte (TCHxL) is read.
In output compare mode (MSxB:MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of the TIM channel x registers
(TCHxH) inhibits output compares until the low byte (TCHxL) is written.
Register Name and Address: TCH0H—$0026
Read:
Write:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TCH0L—$0027
Read:
Write:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-10. TIM Channel 0 Registers (TCH0H and TCH0L)
Register Name and Address: TCH1H—$0029
Read:
Write:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TCH1L—$002A
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-11. TIM Channel 1 Registers (TCH1H and TCH1L)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
132
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12
PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module
12.1 Introduction
This section describes the integrated radio frequency (RF) module. This module integrates an ultra high
frequency (UHF) transmitter offering these key features:
• Switchable frequency bands: 315, 434, and 868 MHz
• On/off keying (OOK) and frequency shift keying (FSK) modulation
• Adjustable output power range
• Fully integrated voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO)
• Supply voltage range: 1.9 to 3.7 V
• Very low standby current: 0.5 nA @ TA = 25°C
• Low supply voltage shutdown
• Data clock output for microcontroller
• Low external component count
Architecture of the module is described in Figure 12-1.
BAND
REXT
VCO
VCC
÷32
÷2
PA
ENABLE
ENABLE_FSK
DATA_OOK
DATA_FSK
MODE
DATA
PFD
FIRST
ORDER
GND
CONTROL
ENABLE
GNDRF
XCO
CFSK
XTAL0
RFOUT
÷64
DRIVER
DATACLK
XTAL1
Figure 12-1. Simplified Integrated RF Module Block Diagram
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
133
PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module
INTERNAL BUS
M68HC08 CPU
CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 32 BYTES
PTA7(2)
PTA6/KBD6(2) (3)
PTA5/KBD5(2) (3)
SECURITY
MODULE
PTA
ARITHMETIC/LOGIC
UNIT (ALU)
DDRA
CPU
REGISTERS
COMPUTER OPERATING
PROPERLY MODULE
PTB
LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT
MODULE
DDRB
MONITOR ROM — 768 BYTES
PTA3/KBD3(2) (3)
PTA2/KBD2(2) (3)
PTA1/KBD1(2) (3)
PTA0(2)
USER FLASH — 2031 BYTES
USER RAM — 128 BYTES
PTA4/KBD4(2) (3)
2-CHANNEL TIMER
MODULE
PTB3/TCLK
PTB2/TCH0
PTB1
PTB0/MCLK
USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 14 BYTES
OSC2
OSC1
SOFTWARE SELECTABLE
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
MODULE
VCC
MODE
RST(1)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
IRQ(1)
KEYBOARD/INTERRUPT
MODULE
ENABLE
DATA
BAND
UHF
TRANSMITTER
RFOUT
GNDRF
REXT
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
XTAL1
XTAL0
DATACLK
VDD
CFSK
POWER
VSS
1. Pin contains integrated pullup resistor
2. High current sink pin
3. Pin contains software selectable pullup resistor
Figure 12-2. Block Diagram Highlighting UHF Transmitter Block and Pins
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
134
Freescale Semiconductor
Transmitter Functional Description
12.2 Transmitter Functional Description
The transmitter is a phase-locked loop (PLL) tuned low-power UHF transmitter. The different modes of
operation are controlled by the microcontroller through several digital input pins. The power supply
voltage ranges from 1.9 V to 3.7 V allowing operation with a single lithium cell.
12.3 Phase-Lock Loop (PLL) and Local Oscillator
The VCO is a completely integrated relaxation oscillator. The phase frequency detector (PFD) and the
loop filter are fully integrated. The exact output frequency is equal to:
fRFOUT = fXTAL x PLL divider ratio
The frequency band of operation is selected through the BAND pin. Table 12-1 provides details for each
frequency band selection.
Table 12-1. Frequency Band Selection
and Associated Divider Ratios
BAND Input
Level
Frequency
Band (MHz)
PLL Divider
Ratio
Crystal Oscillator
Frequency (MHz)
315
High
9.84
32
434
13.56
Low
868
64
An out-of-lock function is performed by monitoring the internal PFD output voltage. When it exceeds its
limits, the RF output stage is disabled.
12.4 RF Output Stage
The output stage is a single-ended square wave switched current source. Harmonics will be present in
the output current drive. Their radiated absolute level depends on the antenna characteristics and output
power. Typical application demonstrates compliance to European Telecommunications Standards
Institute (ETSI) standard. A resistor REXT connected to the REXT pin controls the output power allowing
a tradeoff between radiated power and current consumption. The output voltage is internally clamped to:
VCC ± 2 VBE (typically VCC ±1.5 V @ TA = 25°C)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
135
PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module
12.5 Modulation
If a low-logic level is applied on pin MODE, then the on/off keying (OOK) modulation is selected. This
modulation is performed by switching on/off the RF output stage. The logic level applied on pin DATA
controls the output stage state:
DATA = 0 → output stage off
DATA = 1 → output stage on
If a high-logic level is applied on pin MODE, then frequency shift keying (FSK) modulation is selected.
This modulation is achieved by modulating the frequency of the reference oscillator. This frequency
change is performed by switching the external crystal load capacitor. The logic level applied on pin DATA
controls the internal switch connected to pin CFSK:
DATA = 0 → switch off
DATA = 1 → switch on
In case of Figure 12-6, where the two capacitors C6 and C9 are in series:
DATA = 0 leads to the high value of the carrier frequency
DATA = 1 leads to the low value of the carrier frequency
This crystal pulling solution implies that the RF output frequency deviation equals the crystal frequency
deviation multipled by the PLL divider ratio (see Table 12-1).
12.6 Microcontroller Interfaces
Four digital input pins (ENABLE, DATA, BAND, and MODE) enable the circuit to be controlled by a
microcontroller. It is recommended to configure the band frequency and the modulation type before
enabling the circuit. In a typical application the input pins BAND and MODE are hardwired.
One digital output (DATACLK) provides the microcontroller a reference frequency for data clocking. This
frequency is equal to the crystal oscillator frequency divided by 64 (see Table 12-2).
Table 12-2. DATACLK Frequency
versus Crystal Oscillator Frequency
Crystal Oscillator Frequency
(MHz)
DATACLK Frequency
(kHz)
9.84
154
13.56
212
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
136
Freescale Semiconductor
State Machine
12.7 State Machine
Figure 12-3 details the main state machine.
POWER ON
AND ENABLE = 0
STATE 1
STANDBY MODE
ENABLE = 0
ENABLE = 1
STATE 2
PLL ENABLED
BUT OUT OF LOCK-IN RANGE
PLL IN
LOCK-IN RANGE
ENABLE = 0
STATE 6
SHUTDOWN MODE
PLL OUT OF
LOCK-IN RANGE
VBattery < VShutdoown
STATE 3
PLL ACQUISITION,
READY TO TRANSMIT
DATA
STATE 4
TRANSMISSION MODE
PLL IN
LOCK-IN RANGE
PLL OUT OF
LOCK-IN RANGE
STATE 5
PLL OUT OF LOCK-IN RANGE
Figure 12-3. Main State Machine
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
137
PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module
State 1
The circuit is in standby mode and draws only a leakage current from the power supply.
State 2
In this state, the PLL is enabled but out of the lock-in range. Therefore the RF output stage is switched
off preventing any data transmission. Data clock is available on pin DATACLK. In normal operation,
this state is transitional.
State 3
In this state, the PLL is within the lock-in range.
If t < tPLL_Lock_In, then the PLL can still be in acquisition mode.
If t ≥ tPLL_Lock_In, then the PLL is locked.
The circuit is ready to transmit in band and is waiting for the first data (see Figure 12-4).
State 4
A rising edge on pin DATA starts the transmission. Data entered on pin DATA are output on pin
RFOUT. The modulation is the one selected through the level applied on pin MODE.
State 5
An out-of-lock condition has been detected. The RF output stage is switched off preventing any data
transmission. Data clock is available on pin DATACLK.
State 6
When the supply voltage falls below the shutdown voltage threshold (VSDWN) the whole circuit is
switched off. Applying a low level on pin ENABLE is the only condition to get out of this state.
Figure 12-4 shows the waveforms of the main signals for a typical application cycle
ENABLE
DATACLK
tDATACLK_Settling
tPLL_Lock_In
SEE NOTE
DATA
MODE = 0
OOK MODULATION
RFOUT
MODE = 1
FSK MODULATION
STATE 1
fCarrier
fCarrier1
STATE 2
STATE 3
fCarrier
fCarrier2
fCarrier1
fCarrier2
STATE 4
STATE 1
Note: PLL locked, circuit ready to tramsmit in band.
Figure 12-4. Signals, Waveforms, and Timing Definitions
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
138
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
12.8 Power Management
When the battery voltage falls below the shutdown voltage threshold (VSDWN) the whole circuit is switched
off.
NOTE
After this shutdown, the circuit is latched until a low level is applied on pin
ENABLE (see state 6 under 12.7 State Machine).
12.9 Data Clock
When the data clock starts, the high-to-low ratio may be uneven. Similarly the clock is switched off
asynchronously so the last period length is not guaranteed.
12.10 Application Information
This subsection provides application information for the usage of the UHF transmitter module.
12.10.1 Application Schematics in OOK and FSK Modulation
Figure 12-5 and Figure 12-6 show application schematics in OOK and FSK modulation for the 315-MHz
and 434-MHz frequency bands. For 868-MHz band application, the input pin BAND must be wired to
GND. See component description in Table 12-4 and Table 12-5.
VCC
VCC
TO MCU
DATACLK
Y1
DATA
ENABLE
BAND
VCC
GND
GNDRF
XTAL1
RFOUT
XTAL0
VCC
REXT
C6
R2
MODE
CFSK
MATCHING
NETWORK
ANTENNA
NC
C7
C8
NC = NO CONNECTION
Figure 12-5. Application Schematic in OOK Modulation,
315-MHz and 434-MHz Frequency Bands
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
139
PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module
VCC
VCC
TO MCU
C6
DATACLK
Y1
MODE
DATA
ENABLE
BAND
VCC
GND
GNDRF
XTAL1
RFOUT
XTAL0
VCC
REXT
ANTENNA
CFSK
C7
R2
C9
MATCHING
NETWORK
C8
Figure 12-6. Application Schematic in FSK Modulation,
315-MHz and 434-MHz Frequency Bands
Table 12-3. Component Description
Component
Y1
Function
Crystal
R2
RF output level setting resistor (REXT)
C6
Crystal load capacitor
C7
Value
Unit
315-MHz band: 9.84,
see Table 12-5
MHz
434-MHz band: 13.56,
see Table 12-5
MHz
868-MHz band: 13.56,
see Table 12-5
MHz
12
kΩ
OOK modulation: 18
pF
FSK modulation: 22
pF
10
nF
100
pF
See Table 12-5
pF
Power supply decoupling capacitor
C8
C9
Crystal pulling capacitor for FSK
modulation only
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
140
Freescale Semiconductor
Application Information
A example of crystal reference is: Tokyo Denpa TTS-3B 13568.750 kHz, see Table 12-4.
Table 12-4. Recommended Crystal Characteristics
(SMD Ceramic Package)
Parameter
Value
Unit
Load capacitance
20
pF
Motional capacitance
6.7
fF
Static capacitance
2
pF
Loss resistance
40
W
Table 12-5. Crystal Pulling Capacitor Value
versus Carrier Frequency Total Deviation
Carrier Frequency
(MHz)
Carrier Frequency
Total Deviation
(kHz)
Capacitor Value
(pF)
40
18
70
10
100
6.8
80
18
140
10
200
6.8
434
868
12.10.2 Complete Application Schematic
Figure 12-7 gives a complete application schematic using the Freescale MC68HC908RF2. OOK
modulation is selected, fCarrier = 433.92 MHz.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
141
PLL Tuned UHF Transmitter Module
IRQ1
RST
PTA7
PTA6/KBD6
PTA5/KBD5
PTA4/KBD4
SW2
PTA3/KBD3
PTA2/KBD2
SW1
1
24
2
23
3
22
PTA0
19
7
18
8
OSC2
PTB3/TCLK
DATACLK
DATA
DATA
BAND
VBATT
16
17
15
XTAL0
6
9
Y1
20
14
XTAL1
5
13
GND
C10 18 pF
C3
10 nF
21
MC68HC908RF2
12
PTB2/TCH0
DATA
VSS
OSC1
4
11
PTB1
ENABLE
10
PTB0/MCLK
VDD
25
26
27
28
29
30
32
31
VBATT
PTA1/KBD1
MODE
ENABLE
VCC
GNDDRF
RFOUT
VCC
CFSK
REXT
13.56 MHz
R2 12 K
ENABLE
VBATT
C9
2.2 pF
C6
10 nF
C5
100 pF
Figure 12-7. Complete Application Schematic in OOK Modulation,
434-MHz Frequency Band
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
142
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13
Development Support
13.1 Introduction
This section describes the break module, the monitor module (MON), and the monitor mode entry
methods.
13.2 Break Module (BRK)
The break module can generate a break interrupt that stops normal program flow at a defined address to
enter a background program.
Features include:
• Accessible input/output (I/O) registers during break interrupts
• CPU-generated break interrupts
• Software-generated break interrupts
• COP disabling during break interrupts
13.2.1 Functional Description
When the internal address bus matches the value written in the break address registers, the break module
issues a breakpoint signal to the CPU. The CPU then loads the instruction register with a software
interrupt instruction (SWI) after completion of the current CPU instruction. The program counter vectors
to $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode).
These events can cause a break interrupt to occur:
• A CPU-generated address (the address in the program counter) matches the contents of the break
address registers.
• Software writes a 1 to the BRKA bit in the break status and control register.
When a CPU-generated address matches the contents of the break address registers, the break interrupt
begins after the CPU completes its current instruction. A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the
break routine ends the break interrupt and returns the MCU to normal operation. Figure 13-1 shows the
structure of the break module.
13.2.1.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether module status bits can be cleared during the break
state. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (BFCR) enables software to clear status bits
during the break state. (See 10.7.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register and the Break Interrupts subsection
for each module.)
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
143
Development Support
IAB[15:8]
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH
8-BIT COMPARATOR
IAB[15:0]
CONTROL
BREAK
8-BIT COMPARATOR
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW
IAB[7:0]
Figure 13-1. Break Module Block Diagram
Addr.
Register Name
Read:
Break Address Register High
$FE0C
(BRKH) Write:
See page 146.
Reset:
Read:
Break Address Register Low
$FE0D
(BRKL) Write:
See page 146.
Reset:
$FE0E
Read:
Break Status and Control
Register (BSCR) Write:
See page 145.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BRKE
BRKA
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 13-2. I/O Register Summary
13.2.1.2 CPU During Break Interrupts
The CPU starts a break interrupt by:
• Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction
• Loading the program counter with $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode)
The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in progress. If the break address
register match occurs on the last cycle of a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately.
13.2.1.3 TIM During Break Interrupts
A break interrupt stops the timer counter.
13.2.1.4 COP During Break Interrupts
The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VHI is present on the RST pin.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
144
Freescale Semiconductor
Break Module (BRK)
13.2.2 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes.
13.2.2.1 Wait Mode
If enabled, the break module is active in wait mode.
13.2.2.2 Stop Mode
The break module is inactive in stop mode. The STOP instruction does not affect break module register
states.
13.2.3 Break Module Registers
These registers control and monitor operation of the break module:
• Break status and control register, BSCR
• Break address register high, BRKH
• Break address register low, BRKL
13.2.3.1 Break Status and Control Register
The break status and control register (BSCR) contains break module enable and status bits.
Address:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
$FE0E
Bit 7
6
BRKE
BRKA
0
0
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 13-3. Break Status and Control Register (BSCR)
BRKE — Break Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables breaks on break address register matches. Clear BRKE by writing a 0 to
bit 7. Reset clears the BRKE bit.
1 = Breaks enabled on 16-bit address match
0 = Breaks disabled on 16-bit address match
BRKA — Break Active Bit
This read/write status and control bit is set when a break address match occurs. Writing a 1 to BRKA
generates a break interrupt. Clear BRKA by writing a 0 to it before exiting the break routine.
1 = Break address match
0 = No break address match
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
145
Development Support
13.2.3.2 Break Address Registers
The break address registers contain the high and low bytes of the desired breakpoint address. Reset
clears the break address registers.
Register Name and Address: BRKH — $FE0C
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Register Name and Address: BRKL — $FE0D
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 13-4. Break Address Registers (BRKH and BRKL)
13.3 Monitor Module
This subsection describes the monitor read-only memory (MON). The MON allows complete testing of the
MCU through a single-wire interface with a host computer.
Features include:
• Normal user-mode pin functionality
• One pin dedicated to serial communication between monitor ROM and host computer
• Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) communication with host computer
• 9600 baud communication with host computer when using a 9.8304-MHz crystal
• Execution of code in random-access memory (RAM) or FLASH
• FLASH security
• FLASH programming
13.3.1 Functional Description
Monitor ROM receives and executes commands from a host computer. Figure 13-5 shows a sample
circuit used to enter monitor mode and communicate with a host computer via a standard RS-232
interface.
While simple monitor commands can access any memory address, the MC68HC908RF2A has a FLASH
security feature to prevent external viewing of the contents of FLASH. Proper procedures must be
followed to verify FLASH content. Access to the FLASH is denied to unauthorized users of
customer-specified software (see 13.3.2 Security).
In monitor mode, the MCU can execute host-computer code in RAM while all MCU pins except PTA0
retain normal operating mode functions. All communication between the host computer and the MCU is
through the PTA0 pin. A level-shifting and multiplexing interface is required between PTA0 and the host
computer. PTA0 is used in a wired-OR configuration and requires a pullup resistor.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
146
Freescale Semiconductor
Monitor Module
VDD
68HC908RF2
10 kΩ
RST
0.1 µF
VHI
10 kΩ
IRQ1
1
10 µF
+
3
4
10 µF
MC145407
20
+
OSC1
20 pF
17
+
+
10 µF
18
2
19
DB-25
2
5
16
3
6
15
10 µF
X1
9.8304 MHz
10 MΩ
OSC2
VDD
20 pF
VSS
VDD
VDD
0.1 µF
7
VDD
1
MC74HC125
14
2
3
6
5
VDD
10 kΩ
PTA0
4
VDD
7
10 kΩ
10 kΩ
PTB0
PTB2
Figure 13-5. Monitor Mode Circuit
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
147
Development Support
13.3.1.1 Monitor Mode Entry
Table 13-1 shows the pin conditions for entering monitor mode.
Table 13-1. Monitor Mode Entry
IRQ
Pin
PTB0
Pin
PTB2
Pin
PTA0
Pin
CGMOUNT(1)
Bus
Frequency
VTST(2)
1
0
1
CGMXCLK
----------------------------2
CGMOUT
-------------------------2
1. If the high voltage (VTST) is removed from the IRQ pin while in monitor mode, the clock
select bit (CS) controls the source of CGMOUT.
2. For VTST, see see 14.6 3.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module and 14.2
Absolute Maximum Ratings.
Enter monitor mode by either:
• Executing a software interrupt instruction (SWI), or
• Applying a logic 0 and then a logic 1 to the RST pin
NOTE
Upon entering monitor mode, an interrupt stack frame plus a stacked H
register will leave the stack pointer at address $00F9.
Once out of reset, the MCU waits for the host to send eight security bytes (see 13.3.2 Security). After the
security bytes, the MCU sends a break signal (10 consecutive logic 0s) to the host computer, indicating
that it is ready to receive a command.
Monitor mode uses alternate vectors for reset, SWI, and break interrupt. The alternate vectors are in the
$FE page instead of the $FF page and allow code execution from the internal monitor firmware instead
of user code. The COP module is disabled in monitor mode as long as VHI (see Chapter 14 Electrical
Specifications) is applied to either the IRQ pin or the RST pin. (See Chapter 10 System Integration Module
(SIM) for more information on modes of operation.) The ICG module is bypassed in monitor mode as long
as VHI is applied to the IRQ1 pin. RST does not affect the ICG.
Table 13-2 is a summary of the differences between user mode and monitor mode.
Table 13-2. Mode Differences
Functions
COP
Reset
Vector
High
Reset
Vector
Low
Break
Vector
High
Break
Vector
Low
SWI
Vector
High
SWI
Vector
Low
User
Enabled
$FFFE
$FFFF
$FFFC
$FFFD
$FFFC
$FFFD
Monitor
Disabled(1)
$FEFE
$FEFF
$FEFC
$FEFD
$FEFC
$FEFD
Modes
1. If the high voltage (VHI) is removed from the IRQ pin while in monitor mode, the SIM asserts its
COP enable output. The COP is a mask option enabled or disabled by the COPD bit in the configuration register. See 14.6 3.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
148
Freescale Semiconductor
Monitor Module
13.3.1.2 Data Format
Communication with the monitor ROM is in standard non-return-to-zero (NRZ) mark/space data format.
(See Figure 13-6 and Figure 13-7.)
The data transmit and receive rate is determined by the crystal. Transmit and receive baud rates must be
identical.
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
STOP
BIT
BIT 7
NEXT
START
BIT
1, 2, 3
Notes: 1 = Echo delay (2 bit times)
2 = Data return delay (2 bit times)
3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 13-6. Monitor Data Format
$A5
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
STOP
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
1, 2, 3
BREAK
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
STOP
BIT
Notes: 1 = Echo delay (2 bit times)
2 = Data return delay (2 bit times)
3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
NEXT
START
BIT
1, 2, 3
Figure 13-7. Sample Monitor Waveforms
13.3.1.3 Echoing
As shown in Figure 13-8, the monitor ROM immediately echoes each received byte back to the PTA0 pin
for error checking.
Any result of a command appears after the echo of the last byte of the command.
SENT TO
MONITOR
READ
READ
1
ADDR. HIGH
3
ADDR. HIGH
1
ADDR. LOW
3
ECHO
ADDR. LOW
1
DATA
2
RESULT
Notes: 1 = Echo delay (2 bit times)
2 = Data return delay (2 bit times)
3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 13-8. Read Transaction
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
149
Development Support
13.3.1.4 Break Signal
A start bit followed by nine low bits is a break signal. (See Figure 13-9.) When the monitor receives a break
signal, it drives the PTA0 pin high for the duration of two bits before echoing the break signal.
MISSING STOP BIT
2-STOP-BIT DELAY BEFORE ZERO ECHO
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Figure 13-9. Break Transaction
13.3.1.5 Commands
The monitor ROM firmware uses these commands:
• READ (read memory)
• WRITE (write memory)
• IREAD (indexed read)
• IWRITE (indexed write)
• READSP (read stack pointer)
• RUN (run user program)
The monitor ROM firmware echoes each received byte back to the PTA0 pin for error checking. An 11-bit
delay at the end of each command allows the host to send a break character to cancel the command. A
delay of two bit times occurs before each echo and before READ, IREAD, or READSP data is returned.
The data returned by a read command appears after the echo of the last byte of the command.
NOTE
Wait one bit time after each echo before sending the next byte.
FROM HOST
4
ADDRESS
HIGH
READ
READ
4
1
ADDRESS
HIGH
1
ECHO
Notes:
1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times
2 = Data return delay, 2 bit times
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
4
DATA
1
3, 2
4
RETURN
3 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times
4 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 13-10. Read Transaction
FROM HOST
3
ADDRESS
HIGH
WRITE
WRITE
1
3
ADDRESS
HIGH
1
ADDRESS
LOW
3
ADDRESS
LOW
1
DATA
DATA
3
1
2, 3
ECHO
Notes:
1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times
2 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times
3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 13-11. Write Transaction
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
150
Freescale Semiconductor
Monitor Module
A brief description of each monitor mode command is given in Table 13-3 through Table 13-8.
Table 13-3. READ (Read Memory) Command
Description
Read byte from memory
Operand
2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order
Data Returned
Returns contents of specified address
Opcode
$4A
Command Sequence
SENT TO MONITOR
ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS
HIGH
HIGH
LOW
READ
READ
ADDRESS
LOW
DATA
ECHO
RETURN
Table 13-4. WRITE (Write Memory) Command
Description
Operand
Data Returned
Opcode
Write byte to memory
2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order; low byte followed by data
byte
None
$49
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
WRITE
WRITE
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
DATA
DATA
ECHO
Table 13-5. IREAD (Indexed Read) Command
Description
Operand
Data Returned
Opcode
Read next 2 bytes in memory from last address accessed
2-byte address in high byte:low byte order
None
$1A
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
IREAD
IREAD
DATA
DATA
ECHO
RETURN
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
151
Development Support
Table 13-6. IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command
Description
Operand
Data Returned
Opcode
Write to last address accessed + 1
Single data byte
None
$19
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
IWRITE
IWRITE
DATA
DATA
ECHO
A sequence of IREAD or IWRITE commands can access a block of memory sequentially over the full
64-Kbyte memory map.
Table 13-7. READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command
Description
Operand
Data Returned
Opcode
Reads stack pointer
None
Returns incremented stack pointer value (SP + 1) in
high-byte:low-byte order
$0C
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
READSP
SP
HIGH
READSP
SP
LOW
ECHO
RETURN
Table 13-8. RUN (Run User Program) Command
Description
Executes PULH and RTI instructions
Operand
None
Data Returned
None
Opcode
$28
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
RUN
RUN
ECHO
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
152
Freescale Semiconductor
Monitor Module
The MCU executes the SWI and PSHH instructions when it enters monitor mode. The RUN command
tells the MCU to execute the PULH and RTI instructions. Before sending the RUN command, the host can
modify the stacked CPU registers to prepare to run the host program. The READSP command returns
the incremented stack pointer value, SP + 1. The high and low bytes of the program counter are at
addresses SP + 5 and SP + 6.
SP
HIGH BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER
SP + 1
CONDITION CODE REGISTER
SP + 2
ACCUMULATOR
SP + 3
LOW BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER
SP + 4
HIGH BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER
SP + 5
LOW BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER
SP + 6
SP + 7
Figure 13-12. Stack Pointer at Monitor Mode Entry
13.3.1.6 Baud Rate
With a 9.8304-MHz crystal, data is transferred between the monitor and host at 9600 baud. If a
14.7456-MHz crystal is used, the monitor baud rate is 14400.
NOTE
While in monitor mode with VHI applied to IRQ1, the MCU bus clock is
always driven from the external clock.
13.3.2 Security
A security feature discourages unauthorized reading of FLASH locations while in monitor mode. The host
can bypass the security feature at monitor mode entry by sending eight consecutive security bytes that
match the bytes at locations $FFF6–$FFFD. Locations $FFF6–$FFFD contain user-defined data.
NOTE
Do not leave locations $FFF6–$FFFD blank. For security reasons, program
locations $FFF6–$FFFD even if they are not used for vectors. If FLASH is
unprogrammed, the eight security byte values to be sent are $00, the
unprogrammed state of the FLASH.
During monitor mode entry, the MCU waits after the power-on reset for the host to send the eight security
bytes on pin PA0.
If the received bytes match those at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host bypasses the security feature and
can read all FLASH locations and execute code from FLASH. Security remains bypassed until a power-on
reset occurs. After the host bypasses security, any reset other than a power-on reset requires the host to
send another eight bytes, but security remains bypassed regardless of the data that the host sends.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
153
Development Support
IRQ
SEE NOTE
VDD
4096 + 32 CGMXCLK CYCLES
RST
24 CGMXCLK CYCLES
COMMAND
BYTE 8
$FFFD
BYTE 2
$FFF7
BYTE 1
$FFF6
Note: Any delay between rising IRQ and rising VDD will guarantee that the MCU bus is driven by the external clock.
FROM HOST
PA0
3
BYTE 8 ECHO
2
1
COMMAND ECHO
1
BREAK
1
BYTE 2 ECHO
FROM MCU
3
1
BYTE 1 ECHO
256 CGMXCLK CYCLES
ONE BIT TIME
Notes: 1 = Echo delay (2 bit times)
2 = Data return delay (2 bit times)
3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 13-13. Monitor Mode Entry Timing
If the received bytes do not match the data at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host fails to bypass the
security feature. The MCU remains in monitor mode, but reading FLASH locations returns undefined data,
and trying to execute code from FLASH causes an illegal address reset. After the host fails to bypass
security, any reset other than a power-on reset causes an endless loop of illegal address resets.
After receiving the eight security bytes from the host, the MCU transmits a break character signalling that
it is ready to receive a command.
NOTE
The MCU does not transmit a break character until after the host sends the
eight security bytes.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
154
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14
Electrical Specifications
14.1 Introduction
This section contains electrical and timing specifications.
14.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Maximum ratings are the extreme limits to which the microcontroller unit (MCU) can be exposed without
permanently damaging it.
NOTE
This device is not guaranteed to operate properly at the maximum ratings.
Refer to 14.5 1.8-Volt to 3.3-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding
UHF Module, 14.6 3.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF
Module, 14.7 2.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module,
and 14.8.1 UHF Module Electrical Characteristics for guaranteed operating
conditions.
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Value
Unit
Supply voltage
VDD
–0.3 to +3.6
V
Input voltage
VIn
VSS –0.3 to VDD +0.3
V
ESD HBM voltage capability on each pin(2)
—
± 2000
V
—
± 150
V
I
± 15
mA
IPTA7–IPTA0
± 25
mA
Maximum current out of VSS
IMVSS
100
mA
Maximum current into VDD
IMVDD
100
mA
Storage temperature
TSTG
–55 to +150
°C
ESD MM voltage capability on each
pin(3)
Maximum current per pin excluding VDD, VSS, PTA7–PTA0,
and UHF module pins
Maximum current for pins PTA7–PTA0
1. Voltages referenced to VSS.
2. Human Body Model, AEC-Q100-002 Rev. C
3. Machine Model, AEC-Q100-003 Rev. D
NOTE
This device contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage due to
high static voltages or electric fields; however, it is advised that normal
precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltage higher than
maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. For proper
operation, it is recommended that VIn and VOut be constrained to the range
VSS ≤ (VIn or VOut) ≤ VDD. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused
inputs are connected to an appropriate logic voltage level (for example,
either VSS or VDD).
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
155
Electrical Specifications
14.3 Functional Operating Range
Characteristic
Operating temperature range(1)
Operating voltage range
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Temp.
Code
TA
–40
–40
85
125
°C
C
M
VDD
1.8
3.6
V
–
1. Extended temperature range to be determined
14.4 Thermal Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Value
Unit
Thermal resistance
LQFP (32 pin)
θJA
TBD
°C/W
I/O pin power dissipation
PI/O
User determined
W
Power dissipation(1)
PD
PD = (IDD x VDD) + PI/O =
K/(TJ + 273°C)
W
Constant(2)
K
PD x (TA + 273°C)
+ PD2 x θJA
W/°C
Average junction temperature
TJ
TA + (PD x θJA)
°C
TJM
100
°C
Maximum junction temperature
1. Power dissipation is a function of temperature.
2. K is a constant unique to the device. K can be determined for a known TA and measured PD. With this value of K, PD and
TJ can be determined for any value of TA.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
156
Freescale Semiconductor
1.8-Volt to 3.3-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module
14.5 1.8-Volt to 3.3-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Unit
Output high voltage
(ILoad = –1.2 mA)
(ILoad = –2.0 mA)
VOH
VDD –0.3
VDD –1.0
—
—
—
—
V
Output low voltage
(ILoad = 1.2 mA)
(ILoad = 3.0 mA)
(ILoad = 3.0 mA) PTA7–PTA0 only
VOL
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.3
1.0
0.3
Input high voltage, all ports, IRQ1, OSC1
VIH
0.7 x VDD
—
VDD + 0.3
V
Input low voltage, all ports, IRQ1, OSC1
VIL
VSS
—
0.3 x VDD
V
—
—
—
—
4.3
1.2
mA
mA
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
—
800
—
50
—
—
240
3000
100
—
350
nA
nA
nA
nA
µA
µA
V
VDD supply current
Run(3) (fop= 2.0 MHz)
Wait(4) (fop= 2.0 MHz)
Stop(5)
25°C
–40°C to 85°C
–40°C to 125°C
70°C
25°C with LVI enabled
–40°C to 85°C with LVI enabled
IDD
I/O ports high-impedance leakage current(6)
IIL
—
—
±1
µA
Input current
IIn
—
—
±1
µA
Capacitance
Ports (as input or output)
COut
CIn
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
POR re-arm voltage(7)
VPOR
0
—
200
mV
VPOR
0
700
800
mV
POR rise time ramp rate(9)
RPOR
0.02
—
—
V/ms
Monitor mode entry voltage
VHI
VDD + 2.5
—
8
V
Pullup resistor, PTA6–PTA1, IRQ
RPU
50
80
120
kΩ
POR reset
voltage(8)
1. Parameters are design targets at VDD = 1.8 V to 3.3 V, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25°C only.
3. Run (operating) IDD measured using internal clock generator module (fop= 2.0 MHz). VDD = 3.3 Vdc. All inputs 0.2 V from
rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on all outputs. All ports configured as inputs. CL = 20 pF. OSC2 capacitance linearly
affects run IDD. Measured with all modules enabled.
4. Wait IDD measured using internal clock generator module, fop = 2.0 MHz. All inputs 0.2 V from rail; no dc loads; less than
100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD. All ports configured as inputs.
5. Stop IDD measured with no port pins sourcing current, all modules disabled except as noted.
6. Pullups and pulldowns are disabled.
7. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
8. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is possible.
9. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum
VDD is reached.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
157
Electrical Specifications
14.6 3.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Unit
Output high voltage
(ILoad = –2.0 mA)
(ILoad = –8.0 mA)
VOH
VDD –0.3
VDD –1.0
—
—
—
—
V
Output low voltage
(ILoad = 2.0 mA)
(ILoad = 6.5 mA)
(ILoad = 5.0 mA) PTA7–PTA0 only
VOL
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.3
1.0
0.3
Input high voltage, all ports, IRQ, OSC1
VIH
0.7 x VDD
—
VDD + 0.3
V
Input low voltage, all ports, IRQ, OSC1
VIL
VSS
—
0.3 x VDD
V
—
—
—
—
8.6
1.2
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
—
1100
—
50
—
—
240
3000
100
—
350
nA
nA
nA
µA
µA
V
VDD supply current
Run(3) (fop= 4.0 MHz)
Wait(4) (fop= 4.0 MHz)
Stop(5)
25°C
–40°C to 85°C
–40°C to 125°C
70°C
25°C with LVI enabled
–40°C to 85°C with LVI enabled
IDD
I/O ports high-impedance leakage current(6)
IIL
—
—
±1
µA
Input current
IIn
—
—
±1
µA
Capacitance
Ports (as input or output)
COut
CIn
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
POR re-arm voltage(7)
VPOR
0
—
200
mV
VPOR
0
700
800
mV
RPOR
0.02
—
—
V/ms
Monitor mode entry voltage
VHI
VDD+ 2.5
—
8
V
Pullup resistor, PTA6–PTA1, IRQ
RPU
50
80
120
kΩ
POR reset voltage(8)
(9)
POR rise time ramp rate
mA
mA
1. Parameters are design targets at VDD = 3.0 ± 10%, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25°C only.
3. Run (operating) IDD measured using internal clock generator module (fop= 4.0 MHz). VDD = 3.3 Vdc. All inputs 0.2 V from
rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on all outputs. All ports configured as inputs. CL = 20 pF. OSC2 capacitance linearly
affects run IDD. Measured with all modules enabled.
4. Wait IDD measured using internal clock generator module, fop = 4.0 MHz. All inputs 0.2 V from rail; no dc loads; less than
100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD. All ports configured as inputs.
5. Stop IDD measured with no port pins sourcing current, all modules disabled except as noted.
6. Pullups and pulldowns are disabled.
7. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
8. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is possible.
9. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum
VDD is reached.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
158
Freescale Semiconductor
2.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module
14.7 2.0-Volt DC Electrical Characteristics Excluding UHF Module
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Unit
Output high voltage
(ILoad = –1.2 mA)
(ILoad = –2.0 mA)
VOH
VDD –0.3
VDD –1.0
—
—
—
—
V
Output low voltage
(ILoad = 1.2 mA)
(ILoad = 3.0 mA)
(ILoad = 3.0 mA) PTA7–PTA0 only
VOL
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.3
1.0
0.3
Input high voltage, all ports, IRQ, OSC1
VIH
0.7 x VDD
—
VDD + 0.3
V
Input low voltage, all ports, IRQ, OSC1
VIL
VSS
—
0.3 x VDD
V
—
—
—
—
2.5
850
mA
µA
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
—
1100
—
50
—
—
240
3000
100
—
350
nA
nA
nA
nA
µA
µA
V
VDD supply current
Run(3) (fop= 2.0 MHz)
Wait(4) (fop= 2.0 MHz)
Stop(5)
25°C
–40 °C to 85°C
–40°C to 125°C
70°C
25°C with LVI enabled
–40°C to 85°C with LVI enabled
IDD
I/O ports high-impedance leakage current(6)
IIL
—
—
±1
µA
Input current
IIn
—
—
±1
µA
Capacitance
Ports (as input or output)
COut
CIn
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
POR re-arm voltage(7)
VPOR
0
—
200
mV
VPOR
0
700
800
mV
RPOR
0.02
—
—
V/ms
Monitor mode entry voltage
VHI
VDD+ 2.5
—
8
V
Pullup resistor, PTA6–PTA1, IRQ
RPU
50
80
120
kΩ
POR reset voltage(8)
POR rise time ramp rate
(9)
1. Parameters are design targets at VDD = 2.0 ± 10%, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25°C only.
3. Run (operating) IDD measured using internal clock generator module (fop= 2.0 MHz). VDD = 2.0 Vdc. All inputs 0.2 V from
rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on all outputs. All ports configured as inputs. CL = 20 pF. OSC2 capacitance linearly
affects run IDD. Measured with all modules enabled.
4. Wait IDD measured using internal clock generator module, fop = 2.0 MHz. All inputs 0.2 V from rail; no dc loads; less than
100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD. All ports configured as inputs.
5. Stop IDD measured with no port pins sourcing current, all modules disabled except as noted.
6. Pullups and pulldowns are disabled.
7. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
8. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is possible.
9. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum
VDD is reached.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
159
Electrical Specifications
14.8 UHF Transmitter Module
This subsection provides electrical specifications and timing definitions for the UHF transmitter module.
14.8.1 UHF Module Electrical Characteristics
Unless otherwise specified:
• VCC = 3 V
• REXT = 12 kΩ
• Operating temperature range (TA) = –40°C to 85°C
• RF output frequency: fCarrier = 433.92 MHz
• Reference frequency: fReference =13.56 MHz
• OOK modulation selected
• Output load is 50 Ω resistor (see Figure 14-4)
Values refer to the circuit shown in the recommended application schematic (see Figure 12-5. Application
Schematic in OOK Modulation, 315-MHz and 434-MHz Frequency Bands).
Typical values reflect average measurement at VCC = 3 V, TA = 25°C.
NOTE
Electrical characteristics shown at 125°C are for information only. These
values have not been tested.
Parameter
Test Conditions and Comments
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
TA ≤ 25°C
—
TA = 60°C
—
0.1
5
nA
7
30
nA
TA = 85°C
—
40
100
nA
TA = 125°C
—
800
1700
nA
315 and 434 MHz bands,
continuous wave, TA ≤ 85°C
—
11.6
13.5
mA
315 and 434 MHz bands,
DATA = 0, –40°C ≤ TA ≤ 125°C
—
4.4
6.0
mA
868 MHz band,
DATA = 0, –40°C ≤ TA ≤ 125°C
—
4.6
6.2
mA
315 and 434 MHz bands,
continuous wave, –40°C ≤ TA ≤ 125°C
—
11.6
14.9
mA
868 MHz band,
continuous wave, –40°C ≤ TA ≤ 125°C
—
11.8
15.1
mA
—
3
3.7
V
—
2.04
2.11
V
General Parameters
Supply current
in standby mode
Supply current
in transmission mode
Supply voltage
TA = –40°C
Shutdown voltage
threshold
TA = –20°C
—
1.99
2.06
V
TA = 25°C
—
1.86
1.95
V
TA = 60°C
—
1.76
1.84
V
TA = 85°C
—
1.68
1.78
V
TA = 125°C
—
1.56
1.67
V
Table continued on next page
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
160
Freescale Semiconductor
UHF Transmitter Module
Parameter
Test Conditions and Comments
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
RF Parameters (assuming a 50 Ω matching network connected to the D.U.T. output)
REXT value
Output power
Current and output power
variation vs REXT value
Harmonic 2 level
Harmonic 3 level
Spurious level
@ fCarrier ± f DATACLK
Spurious level
@ fCarrier ± f Reference
Spurious level
@ fCarrier/2
RF spectrum
12
—
21
kΩ
315 and 434 MHz bands,
with 50 Ω matching network
—
5
—
dBm
868 MHz band,
with 50 Ω matching network
—
1
—
dBm
315 and 434 MHz bands,
–40°C ≤ TA ≤ 125°C
–3
0
3
dBm
868 MHz band,
–40°C ≤ TA ≤ 125°C
–7
–3
0
dBm
314 and 434 MHz bands,
with 50 Ω matching network
—
–0.35
—
dB/kΩ
mA/kΩ
315 and 434 MHz bands,
with 50 Ω matching network
—
–34
—
dBc
868 MHz band,
with 50 Ω matching network
—
–49
—
dBc
315 and 434 MHz bands
—
–23
–17
dBc
868 MHz band
—
–38
–27
dBc
315 and 434MHz bands,
with 50 Ω matching network
—
–32
—
dBc
868 MHz band,
with 50 Ω matching network
—
–57
—
dBc
315 and 434 MHz bands
—
–21
–15
dBc
868 MHz band
—
–48
–39
dBc
315 and 434 MHz bands
—
–36
–24
dBc
–29
–17
dBc
868 MHz band
315 MHz band
—
–37
–30
dBc
434 MHz band
—
–44
–34
dBc
868 MHz band
—
–37
–27
dBc
315 MHz bands
—
–62
–53
dBc
434 MHz bands
—
–80
–60
dBc
—
–45
–39
dBc
868 MHz band
434 MHz bands
See Figure 14-1, Figure 14-2, and
Figure 14-3
—
315 and 434 MHz bands,
±175 kHz from f Carrier
—
–75
–68
dBc/Hz
868 MHz band,
±175 kHz from f Carrier
—
–73
–66
dBc/Hz
fCarrier within 30 kHz from the final value,
crystal series resistor = 150 Ω
—
350
1500
µs
XTAL1 input capacitance
—
1
2
pF
Crystal resistance
—
40
200
Ω
Modulation depth
75
90
—
dBc
Phase noise
PLL lock-in time,
tPLL_Lock_In
Table concluded on next page
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
161
Electrical Specifications
Parameter
Test Conditions and Comments
Data rate
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
—
—
10
kBd
0
—
0.3 x VCC
V
0.7 x VCC
—
VCC
V
—
—
150
mV
—
—
100
nA
—
180
—
kΩ
0
—
0.25 x VCC
V
0.75 x VCC
—
VCC
V
Microcontroller Interfaces
Input low voltage
Pins BAND, MODE,
ENABLE, and DATA
Input high voltage
Input hysteresis voltage
Pins BAND, MODE,
DATA @ high level
Input current
ENABLE pulldown resistor
DATACLK output
low voltage
CLoad = 2 pF
DATACLK output
high voltage
DATACLK rising time
DATACLK falling time
DATACLK settling time,
tDATACLK_Settling
CLoad = 2 pF,
measured from 20% to 80%
of the voltage swing
—
250
500
ns
—
150
400
ns
45 < duty cycle fDATACLK < 55%
—
800
1800
µs
Resolution
bandwidth:
100 kHz
Resolution
bandwidth:
30 kHz
Figure 14-1. RF Spectrum at 434-MHz Frequency
Band Displayed with a 5-MHz Span
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
162
Freescale Semiconductor
UHF Transmitter Module
Figure 14-2. RF Spectrum at 434-MHz Frequency Band
Displayed with a 50-MHz Span
Figure 14-3. RF Spectrum at 434-MHz Frequency Band
Displayed with a 1.5-GHz Span
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
163
Electrical Specifications
14.8.2 UHF Module Output Power Measurement
The RF output levels given in the 14.8.1 UHF Module Electrical Characteristics are measured whith a
50-Ω load directly connected to the pin RFOUT as shown in Figure 14-4. This wideband coupling method
gives results independant of the application.
VCC
IMPEDER: TDK MMZ1608Y102CTA00
RFOUT
RF OUTPUT
100 pF
50 Ω
Figure 14-4. Output Power Measurement Configurations
The configuration shown in Figure 14-5(a) provides a better efficiency in terms of output power and
harmonics rejection. Schematic in Figure 14-5(b) gives the equivalent circuit of the pin RFOUT and
impeder as well as the matching network components for 434-MHz frequency band.
NOTE
Note that the impeder is moved to the load side to decrease its influence
(similar to dc bias through the antenna).
Figure 14-6 gives the output power versus the REXT resistor value, in both cases with 50-Ω load and with
matching network.
VCC
IMPEDER: TDK MMZ1608Y102CTA00
RFOUT
RF OUTPUT
MATCHING
NETWORK
(a)
50 Ω
MATCHING
NETWORK
330 pF
L1
C3
39 nH
(b)
50 Ω
3 kΩ
C0
R0
1.5 pF
250 Ω
RFOUT PIN
RI
RL
IMPEDER
LOAD
Figure 14-5. Ouput Characteristic and Matching Network
for 434-MHz Frequency Band
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
164
Freescale Semiconductor
Control Timing
OUTPUT POWER MEASUREMENT IN TYPICAL CONDITIONS
(434 MHz – VCC = 3 V –25°C)
REXT SPECIFIED RANGE
8
6
OUTPUT POWER WHEN MATCHED (dBm)
–0.35 db/kΩ # –0.35 mA/kΩ
RFOUT LEVEL (dBm)
4
2
0
–2
–4
OUTPUT POWER ON 50 Ω LOAD (dBm)
–6
6
9
12
15
REXT (kΩ)
18
21
24
Figure 14-6. Output Power at 434-MHz Frequency Band versus REXT Value
14.9 Control Timing
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Bus operating frequency
VDD = 3.0 V ± 10%
VDD = 2.0 V ± 10%
fBus
32 k
32 k
4.0 M
2.0 M
Hz
RESET pulse width low
tRL
1.5
—
tcyc
IRQ interrupt pulse width low (edge-triggered)
tILHI
1.5
—
tcyc
IRQ interrupt pulse period
tILIL
Note 4
—
tcyc
tTH, tTL
tTLTL
tTCH, tTCL
2
Note(4)
(1/fOP) + 5
—
—
—
tcyc
tcyc
ns
timer(2)
16-bit
Input capture pulse width(3)
Input capture period
Input clock pulse width
1. VDD = 1.8 V to 3.3 V, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = –40oC to +85oC, unless otherwise noted
2. The 2-bit timer prescaler is the limiting factor in determining timer resolution.
3. Refer to Table 11-3. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection and supporting note.
4. The minimum period tTLTL or tILIL should not be less than the number of cycles it takes to execute the capture interrupt
service routine plus 2 tcyc.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
165
Electrical Specifications
14.10 Internal Oscillator Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Internal oscillator base frequency without trim(2) (3)
fINTOSC
230.4
307.2
384.0
kHz
fINTOSC(I)
291.8
307.2
322.6
kHz
N
1
—
127
—
fEXTOSC
128 k
128 k
—
—
16
8
MHz
Internal oscillator base frequency
with trim(2) (3)
Internal oscillator multiplier(4)
(5)
External clock option
3 V ± 10%
2 V ± 10%
1. VDD = 1.8 V to 3.3 V, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = –40oC to +85oC, unless otherwise noted
2. Internal oscillator is selectable through software for a maximum frequency. Actual frequency will be multiplier (N) x base
frequency.
3. fBus = (fINTOSC / 4) x (internal oscillator multiplier)
4. Multiplier must be chosen to limit the maximum bus frequency to the maximum listed in 14.9 Control Timing.
5. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%
14.11 LVI Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
VLVS
1.90
2.00
2.15
V
VLVR
1.73
1.85
2.00
V
LVI trip voltage hysteresis
HLVR
50
70
90
mV
VDD slew rate — rising
SRR
—
—
0.05
V/µs
VDD slew rate — falling
SRF
—
—
0.10
V/µs
Response time — SR ≤ SRmax
tresp
—
—
6.0
µs
Response time — SR > SRmax
tresp
—
—
Note(2)
µs
ten
—
—
50
µs
LVI low battery sense
LVI trip voltage
voltage(1)
(1)
Enable time (enable to output transition)
1. The LVI samples VDD, VLVR, and VLVS are VDD voltages.
2.  V DD – V LVR V DD – V LVR
 ----------------------------------- – ----------------------------------- + 1.5
SR
 SR max

MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
166
Freescale Semiconductor
Memory Characteristics
14.12 Memory Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
VRDR
1.3
—
—
V
FLASH pages per row
—
8
—
8
Pages
FLASH bytes per page
—
1
—
1
Bytes
32 K
—
2.5 M
Hz
RAM data retention voltage
(1)
FLASH read bus clock frequency
fRead
FLASH charge pump clock frequency
(See 2.5.2 FLASH 2TS Charge Pump Frequency Control)
fPump(2)
1.8
—
2.5
MHz
tErase
100
—
—
ms
tRowErase
30
—
—
ms
tKill
200
—
—
µs
50
—
—
µs
FLASH block/bulk erase time
FLASH row erase time
FLASH high voltage kill time
FLASH return to read time
tHVD
(3)
—
—
15
Pulses
FLASH page program step size
tStep
(4)
1.0
—
1.2
ms
FLASH cumulative program time per row
between erase cycles
tRow(5)
—
—
8
Page
program
cycles
FLASH HVEN low to MARGIN high time
tHVTV
50
—
—
µs
FLASH MARGIN high to PGM low time
tVTP
150
—
—
µs
—
104
-—
-—
Cycles
—
15
100
-—
Years
FLASH page program pulses
flsPulses
(6)
FLASH 2TS row program endurance
FLASH data retention
time(7)
1. fRead is defined as the frequency range for which the FLASH memory can be read.
2. fPump is defined as the charge pump clock frequency required for program, erase, and margin read operations.
3. flsPulses is defined as the number of pulses used to program the FLASH using the required smart program algorithm.
4. tStep is defined as the amount of time during one page program cycle that HVEN is held high.
5. tRow is defined as the cumulative time a row can see the program voltage before the row must be erased before further
programming.
6. The minimum row endurance value specifies each row of the FLASH 2TS memory is guaranteed to work for at least this
many erase/program cycles.
7. The FLASH is guaranteed to retain data over the entire temperature range for at least the minimum time specified.
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
167
Electrical Specifications
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
168
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
15.1 Introduction
This section contains ordering information for the MC68HC908RF2. In addition, package dimensions are
given for the 32-pin low-profile quad flat pack (LQFP).
15.2 MC Order Numbers
Table 15-1. MC Order Numbers
MC Order Number(1)
Operating
Temperature Range
MC68HC908RF2CFA
–40°C to +85°C
MC68HC908RF2MFA
–40°C to 125°C
1. FA = Low-profile quad flat pack (LQFP)
MC68HC908RF2XXX
FAMILY
PACKAGE DESIGNATOR
TEMPERATURE RANGE
Figure 15-1. Device Numbering System
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
Freescale Semiconductor
169
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
A
–T–, –U–, –Z–
15.3 32-Pin LQFP Package (Case No. 873A)
4X
A1
32
0.20 (0.008) AB T–U Z
25
1
–U–
–T–
B
V
AE
P
B1
DETAIL Y
17
8
V1
AE
DETAIL Y
9
4X
–Z–
9
0.20 (0.008) AC T–U Z
S1
S
DETAIL AD
G
–AB–
0.10 (0.004) AC
AC T–U Z
–AC–
BASE
METAL
ÉÉ
ÉÉ
ÉÉ
ÉÉ
F
8X
M_
R
J
M
N
D
0.20 (0.008)
SEATING
PLANE
SECTION AE–AE
W
K
X
DETAIL AD
Q_
GAUGE PLANE
H
0.250 (0.010)
C E
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
Y14.5M, 1982.
2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER.
3. DATUM PLANE –AB– IS LOCATED AT BOTTOM
OF LEAD AND IS COINCIDENT WITH THE LEAD
WHERE THE LEAD EXITS THE PLASTIC BODY AT
THE BOTTOM OF THE PARTING LINE.
4. DATUMS –T–, –U–, AND –Z– TO BE DETERMINED
AT DATUM PLANE –AB–.
5. DIMENSIONS S AND V TO BE DETERMINED AT
SEATING PLANE –AC–.
6. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE PROTRUSION IS
0.250 (0.010) PER SIDE. DIMENSIONS A AND B
DO INCLUDE MOLD MISMATCH AND ARE
DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE –AB–.
7. DIMENSION D DOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION. DAMBAR PROTRUSION SHALL
NOT CAUSE THE D DIMENSION TO EXCEED
0.520 (0.020).
8. MINIMUM SOLDER PLATE THICKNESS SHALL BE
0.0076 (0.0003).
9. EXACT SHAPE OF EACH CORNER MAY VARY
FROM DEPICTION.
DIM
A
A1
B
B1
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
M
N
P
Q
R
S
S1
V
V1
W
X
MILLIMETERS
MIN
MAX
7.000 BSC
3.500 BSC
7.000 BSC
3.500 BSC
1.400
1.600
0.300
0.450
1.350
1.450
0.300
0.400
0.800 BSC
0.050
0.150
0.090
0.200
0.500
0.700
12_ REF
0.090
0.160
0.400 BSC
1_
5_
0.150
0.250
9.000 BSC
4.500 BSC
9.000 BSC
4.500 BSC
0.200 REF
1.000 REF
INCHES
MIN
MAX
0.276 BSC
0.138 BSC
0.276 BSC
0.138 BSC
0.055
0.063
0.012
0.018
0.053
0.057
0.012
0.016
0.031 BSC
0.002
0.006
0.004
0.008
0.020
0.028
12_ REF
0.004
0.006
0.016 BSC
1_
5_
0.006
0.010
0.354 BSC
0.177 BSC
0.354 BSC
0.177 BSC
0.008 REF
0.039 REF
MC68HC908RF2A Data Sheet, Rev. 0
170
Freescale Semiconductor
How to Reach Us:
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software implementers to use
Freescale Semiconductor products. There are no express or implied copyright licenses granted
USA/Europe/Locations not listed:
Freescale Semiconductor Literature Distribution
P.O. Box 5405, Denver, Colorado 80217
1-800-521-6274 or 480-768-2130
hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or integrated circuits based on the information
in this document.
Freescale Semiconductor reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products
herein. Freescale Semiconductor makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the
Japan:
Freescale Semiconductor Japan Ltd.
SPS, Technical Information Center
3-20-1, Minami-Azabu
Minato-ku
Tokyo 106-8573, Japan
81-3-3440-3569
suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Freescale Semiconductor assume any
liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any
and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters
which may be provided in Freescale Semiconductor data sheets and/or specifications can and do
vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating parameters,
including “Typicals” must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts.
Asia/Pacific:
Freescale Semiconductor H.K. Ltd.
2 Dai King Street
Tai Po Industrial Estate
Tai Po, N.T. Hong Kong
852-26668334
Freescale Semiconductor does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others.
Freescale Semiconductor products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components
in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or
sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Freescale Semiconductor product
could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use
Learn More:
For more information about Freescale
Semiconductor products, please visit
http://www.freescale.com
Freescale Semiconductor products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall
indemnify and hold Freescale Semiconductor and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and
distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney
fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such
unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Freescale Semiconductor was
negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. All other
product or service names are the property of their respective owners.
© Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 2004.
MC68HC908RF2A
Rev. 0, 10/2004
RoHS-compliant and/or Pb- free versions of Freescale products have the functionality
and electrical characteristics of their non-RoHS-compliant and/or non-Pb- free
counterparts. For further information, see http://www.freescale.com or contact your
Freescale sales representative.
For information on Freescale.s Environmental Products program, go to
http://www.freescale.com/epp.